blob: 530236da9ca22281743bb753ff7247a96ce7438f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
William Lallemand4f392792020-06-12 17:31:06 +02007 2020/06/12
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100369 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
370 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
372 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
373 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
374 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
375 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
376 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
377 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
378
379The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3804.2).
381
382
3831.3.2. The response headers
384---------------------------
385
386Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
387the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
388details.
389
390
3912. Configuring HAProxy
392----------------------
393
3942.1. Configuration file format
395------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200396
397HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
398
399 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
400 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
401 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
402 "frontend" and "backend".
403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
405referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200408
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004092.2. Quoting and escaping
410-------------------------
411
412HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
413many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
414with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
415single quotes.
416
417If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
418them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
419escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
420
421Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
422
423 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
424 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
425 \\ to use a backslash
426 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
427 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
428
429Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
430the interpretation of:
431
432 space as a parameter separator
433 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
434 # hash as a comment start
435
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200436Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
437-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
438backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
439
440Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200441quoting.
442
443Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
444nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
445
446Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
447equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
448
449 Example:
450 # those are equivalents:
451 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
453 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
454 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
455 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
456
457 # those are equivalents:
458 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
460 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
461 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
462
463
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004642.3. Environment variables
465--------------------------
466
467HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
468interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
469configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
470optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
471shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
472underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
473
474 Example:
475
476 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
477
478 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
479
480 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
481
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200482Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
483file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200484
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200485* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
486 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
487
488* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
489 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
490 directory.
491
492* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
493
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500494* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495 processes, separated by semicolons.
496
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500497* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200498 CLI, separated by semicolons.
499
500See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200501
5022.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200503----------------
504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100505Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100506values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
507otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
508numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
509for every keyword. Supported units are :
510
511 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
512 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
513 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
514 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
515 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
516 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
517
518
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005192.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200520-------------
521
522 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
523 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
524 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
525 global
526 daemon
527 maxconn 256
528
529 defaults
530 mode http
531 timeout connect 5000ms
532 timeout client 50000ms
533 timeout server 50000ms
534
535 frontend http-in
536 bind *:80
537 default_backend servers
538
539 backend servers
540 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
541
542
543 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
544 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
545 global
546 daemon
547 maxconn 256
548
549 defaults
550 mode http
551 timeout connect 5000ms
552 timeout client 50000ms
553 timeout server 50000ms
554
555 listen http-in
556 bind *:80
557 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
558
559
560Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
561
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100562 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200563
564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005653. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566--------------------
567
568Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
569are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
570of them have command-line equivalents.
571
572The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
573
574 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200577 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200580 - description
581 - deviceatlas-json-file
582 - deviceatlas-log-level
583 - deviceatlas-separator
584 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900585 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - gid
587 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100588 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200589 - h1-case-adjust
590 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100593 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200595 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200597 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200598 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100600 - presetenv
601 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - uid
603 - ulimit-n
604 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200605 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100606 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200607 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200609 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - ssl-default-bind-options
611 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200612 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - ssl-default-server-options
614 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100615 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100616 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100617 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100618 - 51degrees-data-file
619 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200620 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200621 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200622 - wurfl-data-file
623 - wurfl-information-list
624 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200625 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200628 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200630 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100631 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100632 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100633 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200634 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200635 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200636 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200637 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638 - noepoll
639 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000640 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100642 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300643 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000644 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100645 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200646 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200647 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200648 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000649 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000650 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200651 - tune.buffers.limit
652 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200653 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200654 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100655 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200656 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200657 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200658 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100659 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200660 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200661 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100662 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100664 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100665 - tune.lua.session-timeout
666 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200667 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100668 - tune.maxaccept
669 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200670 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200671 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200672 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100673 - tune.rcvbuf.client
674 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100675 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200676 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100677 - tune.sndbuf.client
678 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100679 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200681 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100682 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200683 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200684 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100685 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100687 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200688 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
689 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
690 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100691 - tune.zlib.memlevel
692 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100693
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 * Debugging
695 - debug
696 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697
698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006993.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700------------------------------------
701
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200702ca-base <dir>
703 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200704 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
705 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707chroot <jail dir>
708 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
709 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
710 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
711 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
712 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100713 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100714
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100715cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
716 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
717 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
718 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
719 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
720 set. These sets have the format
721
722 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
723
724 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100725 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100726 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
727 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
729 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100731 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100733 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100734 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
735 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
736 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
737 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100738
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100739 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
740 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
741 on the machine's word size.
742
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100743 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
745 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
746 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
747 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
748 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
749 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100750
751 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
755 # first 4 CPUs
756
757 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
758 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
759 # word size.
760
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100763 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
764 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
765 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
766
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
768 # and so on.
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
770 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
771 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
772
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100773 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
775 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
776 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
777
778 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
780 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
781
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100782 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
783 # and a thread range.
784 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
785 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
786 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
787
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200788crt-base <dir>
789 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
790 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
791 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793daemon
794 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
795 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100796 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
797 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799deviceatlas-json-file <path>
800 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802
803deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100804 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200805 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
806
807deviceatlas-separator <char>
808 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
809 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
810
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100811deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200812 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
813 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
814 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100815
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900816external-check
817 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
818 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
819 See "option external-check".
820
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821gid <number>
822 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
823 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
824 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100825 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
826 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100828
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100829group <group name>
830 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
831 See also "gid" and "user".
832
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100833hard-stop-after <time>
834 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
835
836 Arguments :
837 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
838 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
839 SIGUSR1 signal.
840
841 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
842 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
843 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
844
845 Example:
846 global
847 hard-stop-after 30s
848
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200849h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
850 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
851 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
852 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
853 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500854 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200855 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
856 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
857 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
858 specified in a proxy.
859
860 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
861 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
862 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
863 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
864 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
865 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
866 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
867
868 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
869 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
870 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
871 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
872 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
873
874 Example:
875 global
876 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
877
878 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
879 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
880
881h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
882 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
883 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
884 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
885 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
886 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
887 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
888 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
889 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
890
891 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
892 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
893 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
894
895 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
896 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
897
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200898log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
899 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100900 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100901 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100902 configured with "log global".
903
904 <address> can be one of:
905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100906 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100907 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
908 port).
909
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100910 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
911 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
912 port).
913
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100914 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
916 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100917 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100918
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100919 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
920 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
921 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
922 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
923 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
924 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
925 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
926 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
927 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
928 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
929 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
930 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
931 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
932 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100933 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
934 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100935
936 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
937 "fd@2", see above.
938
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200939 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
940 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100941
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200942 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
943 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
944 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
945 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
946 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
947 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
948 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
949 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
950 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
951 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100952 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
953 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200954
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200955 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
956 one of the following :
957
958 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
960
961 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
962 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
963
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100964 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
965 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
966 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
967 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
968 logger consumes.
969
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100970 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
971 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
972 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
973 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
974
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200975 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
976 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
977 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
978 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
979 set with <sample_size> parameter.
980
981 <sample_size>
982 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
983 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
984 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
985 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
986 (see also <ranges> parameter).
987
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100990 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
991 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
992 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
993
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100994 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
995 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
996 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
997 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998
999 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001000 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1001 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1002 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1003 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1004 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1005 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001007 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001008
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001009log-send-hostname [<string>]
1010 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1011 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1012 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1013 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1014 the logs.
1015
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001016log-tag <string>
1017 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1018 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1019 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001020 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001021
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001022lua-load <file>
1023 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1024 used multiple times.
1025
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001026master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001027 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1028 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1029 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001031 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1032 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001033 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1034 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1035 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1036 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1037 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001039 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001040
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001041mworker-max-reloads <number>
1042 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001043 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001044 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1045 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1046 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048nbproc <number>
1049 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1050 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1051 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001052 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1053 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001054 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1055 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001057nbthread <number>
1058 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001059 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1060 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1061 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1062 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1063 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001064 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1065 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1066 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1067 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1068 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1069 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1070 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001071
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001073 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001074 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1075 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1076
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001077presetenv <name> <value>
1078 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1079 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1080 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1081 and "unsetenv".
1082
1083resetenv [<name> ...]
1084 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1085 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1086 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1087 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1088 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1089 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1090 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1091 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1092
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001093stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001094 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1095 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1096 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1097 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1098 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1099 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001100 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001101 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1102 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1103 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1104 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001105
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001106server-state-base <directory>
1107 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001108 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1109 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001110
1111server-state-file <file>
1112 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1113 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1114 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1115 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1116 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1117 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1118 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1119 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001120 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1121 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001122
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001123setenv <name> <value>
1124 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1125 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1126 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1127 and "unsetenv".
1128
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001129set-dumpable
1130 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1131 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1132 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1133 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1134 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1135 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1136 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1137 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1138 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1139 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1140 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1141 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1142 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1143 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1144 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1145 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1146 expected when dying.
1147
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001148ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1150 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001151 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001152 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001153 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1154 information and recommendations see e.g.
1155 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1156 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1157 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1158 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001159
1160ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1162 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1163 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1164 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1165 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001166 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1167 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1168 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001169 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001170
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001171ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1173 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1174 keyword to see available options.
1175
1176 Example:
1177 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001178 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001179
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001180ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1182 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001183 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001184 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001185 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1186 information and recommendations see e.g.
1187 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1188 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1189 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1190 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1191 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001192
1193ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1195 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1196 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1197 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1198 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001199 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1200 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1201 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1202 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001203
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001204ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1205 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1206 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1207 keyword to see available options.
1208
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001209ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1211 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1212 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001213 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001214 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001215 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1216 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1217 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1218 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001219 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1220 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1221 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1222
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001223ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1224 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1225 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1226 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1227
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001228stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1229 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1230 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1231 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001232 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001233 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001234
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001235 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1236 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1237 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001238
1239stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1240 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1241 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001242 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001243
1244stats maxconn <connections>
1245 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1246 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1247
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001248uid <number>
1249 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1250 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1251 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1252 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1253
1254ulimit-n <number>
1255 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1256 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1257 option.
1258
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001259unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1260 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1261
1262 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1263 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1264 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1265 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1266 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1267 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1268 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1269 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1270 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1271 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1272
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001273unsetenv [<name> ...]
1274 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1275 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1276 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1277 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1278 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1279 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1280 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1281
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001282user <user name>
1283 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1284 See also "uid" and "group".
1285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001286node <name>
1287 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1288
1289 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1290 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1291 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1292 traffic.
1293
1294description <text>
1295 Add a text that describes the instance.
1296
1297 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1298 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1299 "<" and ">" characters.
1300
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100130151degrees-data-file <file path>
1302 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001303 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001305 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001306 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1307
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001309 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1310 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1311 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1312
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001313 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001314 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1315
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001317 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1318 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1319
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001320 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1321 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1322
132351degrees-cache-size <number>
1324 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1325 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1326 By default, this cache is disabled.
1327
1328 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001329 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1330
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001331wurfl-data-file <file path>
1332 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1333 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1334
1335 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1336 with USE_WURFL=1.
1337
1338wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1339 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1340 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1341 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1342
1343 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1344
1345 Valid WURFL properties are:
1346 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1347
1348 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1349 device.
1350
1351 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1352 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1353
1354 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1355 particular web request.
1356
1357 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1358 used Libwurfl API version.
1359
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001360 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1361 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1362
1363 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1364 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1365
1366 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1367
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001368 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1369 with USE_WURFL=1.
1370
1371wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1372 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1373 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1374
1375 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1376 with USE_WURFL=1.
1377
1378wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1379 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1380 thus before the chroot.
1381
1382 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1383 with USE_WURFL=1.
1384
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001385wurfl-cache-size <size>
1386 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1387 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001389 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001390
1391 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1392 with USE_WURFL=1.
1393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001395-----------------------
1396
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001397busy-polling
1398 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1399 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1400 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1401 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1402 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1403 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1404 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1405 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1406 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1407 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1408 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1409 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1410 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1411 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1412 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1413 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1414 "poll" pollers.
1415
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001416 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1417 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1418 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1419
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001420max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1421 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1422 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1423 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1424 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1425 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1426 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1427 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1428 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1429
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001430maxconn <number>
1431 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1432 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1433 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001434 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1435 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1436 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1437 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001438 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1439 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1440 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1441 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1442 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1443 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001445maxconnrate <number>
1446 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1447 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1448 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1449 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1450 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1451 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1452 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1453 fairness.
1454
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001455maxcomprate <number>
1456 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001457 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001458 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1459 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1460 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001461 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001462 default value.
1463
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001464maxcompcpuusage <number>
1465 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1466 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1467 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1468 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1469 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1470 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1471 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1472 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1473
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001474maxpipes <number>
1475 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1476 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1477 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1478 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1479 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1480 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1481
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001482maxsessrate <number>
1483 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1484 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1485 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1486 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1487 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1488 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1489 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1490 fairness.
1491
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001492maxsslconn <number>
1493 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1494 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1495 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1496 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1497 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1498 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1499 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001500 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1501 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1502 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1503 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1504 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1505 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1506 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001507
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001508maxsslrate <number>
1509 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1510 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1511 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1512 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1513 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1514 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1515 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1516 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1517 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1518 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1519
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001520maxzlibmem <number>
1521 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1522 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1523 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001524 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1525 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1526 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1527
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001528noepoll
1529 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1530 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001531 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001532
1533nokqueue
1534 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1535 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1536 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1537
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001538noevports
1539 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1540 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1541 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1542 also "nopoll".
1543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001544nopoll
1545 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1546 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001548 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1549 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001550
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001551nosplice
1552 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001553 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001555 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001556 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1557 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1558 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1559 "option splice-response".
1560
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001561nogetaddrinfo
1562 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1563 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1564
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001565noreuseport
1566 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1567 command line argument "-dR".
1568
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001569profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1570 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1571 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1572 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1573 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001574 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001575 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1576 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1577 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1578 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1579
1580 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1581 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1582 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1583 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1584 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001585 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1586 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1587 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1588 CLI.
1589
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001590spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001591 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1592 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1593 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1594 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1595 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1596 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001600 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001601 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1602 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1603 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1604 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1605 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001606 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1607 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001608 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1609 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1610 openssl configuration file uses:
1611 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1612
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001613ssl-mode-async
1614 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001615 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001616 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1617 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1618 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001619 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001620 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001621
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001622tune.buffers.limit <number>
1623 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1624 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1625 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1626 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1627 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001628 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001629 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1630 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1631 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1632 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1633 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1634 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1635 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1636 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1637 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1638
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001639tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1640 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1641 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1642 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1643 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1644
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001645tune.bufsize <number>
1646 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1647 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1648 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1649 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1650 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1651 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1652 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001653 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1654 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1655 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001656 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001657 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1658 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1659 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001660
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001661tune.chksize <number>
1662 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1663 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1664 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1665 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1666 checks whenever possible.
1667
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001668tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1669 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1670 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1671 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1672 this value. The default value is 1.
1673
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001674tune.fail-alloc
1675 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1676 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1677 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1678 gracefully.
1679
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001680tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1681 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1682 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1683 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1684 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1685 change it.
1686
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001687tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1688 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001689 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1690 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001691 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1692 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1693 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1694 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1695 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1696
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001697tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1698 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1699 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1700 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1701 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1702 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1703 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1704 recommended not to change this value.
1705
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001706tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1707 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1708 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1709 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1710 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1711 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1712 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1713 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1714
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001715tune.http.cookielen <number>
1716 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1717 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1718 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1719 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1720 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1721 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1722 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1723 to change this value.
1724
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001725tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1727 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001729 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001730 configuration directives too.
1731 The default value is 1024.
1732
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001733tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1734 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1735 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1736 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1737 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1738 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1739 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001740 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1741 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1742 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001743
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001744tune.idletimer <timeout>
1745 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1746 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1747 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1748 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1749 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1750 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001751 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001752 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001753 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1754
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001755tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1756 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1757 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1758 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1759 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1760 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1761 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1762 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1763 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1764 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1765
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1767 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001768 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001769 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1770 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001772 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1773 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1774
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001775tune.lua.maxmem
1776 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1777 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1778 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1779 memory.
1780
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001781tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1782 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001783 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1784 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001785 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001786
1787tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1788 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1789 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1790 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1791 check servers.
1792
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001793tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1794 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1795 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1796 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001798
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001799tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001800 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1801 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1802 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1803 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1804 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1805 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1806 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1807 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1808 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1809 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001810
1811tune.maxpollevents <number>
1812 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1813 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1814 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1815 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1816 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.maxrewrite <number>
1819 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1820 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1821 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1822 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1823 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1824 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1825 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1826 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1827 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1828 bufsize.
1829
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001830tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1831 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1832 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1833 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1834 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1835 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1836 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1837 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1838 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1839 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001840 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1841 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001842 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1843 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1844 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1845 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1846 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1847 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1848 setting this parameter to 0.
1849
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001850tune.pipesize <number>
1851 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1852 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1853 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1854 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1855 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1856 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1857
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001858tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1859 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1860 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1861 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1862 default is 20.
1863
1864tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1865 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1866 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1867 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1868 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1869 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1870 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001871 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001872
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001873tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1874tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1875 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1876 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1877 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001878 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001879 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001880 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1881 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1882
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001884 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001885 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1886 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1887 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1888 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1889
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001891 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001892 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1893 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1894
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001895tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1896tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1897 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1898 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1899 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001900 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001902 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1903 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1904 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1905 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1906 notifying haproxy again.
1907
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001908tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001909 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1910 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1911 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001912 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001914 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001915 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1916 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1917 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001918 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1919 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001920
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001922 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001923 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1924 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1925 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1926 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1927 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1928
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001929tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1930 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001931 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001932 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1933 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1934 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1935 being used for too long.
1936
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001937tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1938 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1939 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1940 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1941 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1942 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1943 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1944 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1945 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1946 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1947 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001948 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001949 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001950
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001951tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1952 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1953 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1954 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1955 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1956 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1957 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1958 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001959 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1960 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001961
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001962tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1963 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1964 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1965 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1966 1000 entries.
1967
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001968tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1969 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1970 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1971 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1972
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001974tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001975tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1976tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1977tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001978 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1979 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1980 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1981 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1982 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1983 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1984 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1985 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001986
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001987 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1988 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1989 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1990 all available space is consumed.
1991 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1992 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1993 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001994
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001995tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1996 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001997 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001999 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002000 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2001
2002tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2003 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2004 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002005 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2006 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020083.3. Debugging
2009--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002010
2011debug
2012 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2013 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2014 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2015 system startup.
2016
2017quiet
2018 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2019 line argument "-q".
2020
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020223.4. Userlists
2023--------------
2024It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2025http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2026it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2027
2028userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002029 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002030 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2031
2032group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002033 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002034 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2035 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2036
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002037user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2038 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002039 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2040 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002041 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2042 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2043 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2044 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002045
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002046 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2047 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2048 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2049 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2050 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2051 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2052 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2053 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2054 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002055
2056 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002057 userlist L1
2058 group G1 users tiger,scott
2059 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002060
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002061 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2062 user scott insecure-password elgato
2063 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002064
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002065 userlist L2
2066 group G1
2067 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002068
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002069 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2070 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2071 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002072
2073 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002074
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002075
20763.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002077----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002078It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2079several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2080instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2081values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2082automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2083In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2084using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2085tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2086reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2087Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2088that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2089each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002090
2091peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002092 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002093 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2094
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002095bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2096 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2097 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2098
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002099disabled
2100 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2101 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2102 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2103
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002104default-bind [param*]
2105 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2106
2107default-server [param*]
2108 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2109
2110 Arguments:
2111 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2112 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2113 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2114 details.
2115
2116
2117 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2118
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002119enable
2120 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2121
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002122peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002123 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2124 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2125 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2126 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2127 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2128 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2129
2130 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2131 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2132
2133 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2134 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2135 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2136 across all peers.
2137
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002138 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2139 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002140
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002141 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2142 "server" keyword explanation below).
2143
2144server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002145 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002146 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2147 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2148 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2149 of this "peers" section).
2150 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2151
2152
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002153 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002154 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002155 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002156 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2157 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2158 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002159
2160 backend mybackend
2161 mode tcp
2162 balance roundrobin
2163 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2164 stick on src
2165
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002166 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2167 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002168
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002169 Example:
2170 peers mypeers
2171 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2172 default-server ssl verify none
2173 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2174 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002175
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002176
2177table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2178 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2179
2180 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2181 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002182 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002183 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2184 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2185 "stick-table" keyword).
2186
2187 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2188 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2189 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2190 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2191 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2192 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2193 of the stick-table name as follows:
2194
2195 peers mypeers
2196 peer A ...
2197 peer B ...
2198 table t1 ...
2199
2200 frontend fe1
2201 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2202
2203 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2204 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2205
2206 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2207 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2208 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2209 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2210 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2211 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2212 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2213
2214 peers mypeers
2215 peer A ...
2216 peer B ...
2217 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2218
2219 backend t1
2220 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2221
2222 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2223 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2224 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2225
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022263.6. Mailers
2227------------
2228It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2229If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2230in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2231
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002232mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002233 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2234 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2235
2236mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2237 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2238
2239 Example:
2240 mailers mymailers
2241 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2242 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2243
2244 backend mybackend
2245 mode tcp
2246 balance roundrobin
2247
2248 email-alert mailers mymailers
2249 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2250 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2251
2252 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2253 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2254
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002255timeout mail <time>
2256 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2257 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2258 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2259 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2260
2261 Example:
2262 mailers mymailers
2263 timeout mail 20s
2264 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002265
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022663.7. Programs
2267-------------
2268In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2269master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2270managed the same way as the workers.
2271
2272During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2273sequence as a worker:
2274
2275 - the master is re-executed
2276 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2277 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2278 instance of the program
2279
2280During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2281
2282program <name>
2283 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2284 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2285 the management guide).
2286
2287command <command> [arguments*]
2288 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2289 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2290 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2291 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2292
2293option start-on-reload
2294no option start-on-reload
2295 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2296 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2297 program section.
2298
2299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023004. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002304 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305 - frontend <name>
2306 - backend <name>
2307 - listen <name>
2308
2309A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2310its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2311section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002313
2314A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2315connections.
2316
2317A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2318to forward incoming connections.
2319
2320A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2321parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2324'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2325case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2326
2327Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2328logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2329proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2330However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2331name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2332
2333Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2334and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002335bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2337modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2338arbitrary criteria.
2339
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002340In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2341a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002342the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002343
2344 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2345 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2346 between responses and new requests.
2347
2348 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2349 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2350 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002351 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2352 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2353 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2354 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002355
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002356 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2357 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2358 client-facing connection remains open.
2359
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002360 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2361 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002362
2363The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2364frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2365following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002369
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002370 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2373 ----+-----+-----+----
2374 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2375 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2376 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2377 ----+-----+-----+----
2378 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023824.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2383--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002385The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2386limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2387they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2388limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002390option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002391and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2392with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2393specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002395
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2397------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2398acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002399backlog X X X -
2400balance X - X X
2401bind - X X -
2402bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002403block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002404capture cookie - X X -
2405capture request header - X X -
2406capture response header - X X -
2407clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002408compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2410cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002411declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412default-server X - X X
2413default_backend X X X -
2414description - X X X
2415disabled X X X X
2416dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002418email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419email-alert mailers X X X X
2420email-alert myhostname X X X X
2421email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002422enabled X X X X
2423errorfile X X X X
2424errorloc X X X X
2425errorloc302 X X X X
2426-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2427errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002428force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002429filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002430fullconn X - X X
2431grace X X X X
2432hash-type X - X X
2433http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002434http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002435http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002436http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002437http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002438http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002439http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002440id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002441ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002442load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002443log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002444log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002445log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002446log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002447max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002448maxconn X X X -
2449mode X X X X
2450monitor fail - X X -
2451monitor-net X X X -
2452monitor-uri X X X -
2453option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2454option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2455option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2456option allbackups (*) X - X X
2457option checkcache (*) X - X X
2458option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2459option contstats (*) X X X -
2460option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2461option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2463option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002464option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2465option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002466option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002467option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002468option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002469option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002470option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002472option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002474option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002475option httpchk X - X X
2476option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002477option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002478option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002479option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002480option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002481option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2483option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2484option logasap (*) X X X -
2485option mysql-check X - X X
2486option nolinger (*) X X X X
2487option originalto X X X X
2488option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002489option pgsql-check X - X X
2490option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002492option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002493option smtpchk X - X X
2494option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2495option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2496option splice-request (*) X X X X
2497option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002498option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002499option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2500option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2501-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002502option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002503option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2504option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2505option tcpka X X X X
2506option tcplog X X X X
2507option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002508external-check command X - X X
2509external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2511rate-limit sessions X X X -
2512redirect - X X X
2513redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2514redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002515reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2525reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2526reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002528reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002529retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002530retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002531rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2535rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2536rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2537rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002538server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002539server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002540server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002541source X - X X
2542srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002543stats admin - X X X
2544stats auth X X X X
2545stats enable X X X X
2546stats hide-version X X X X
2547stats http-request - X X X
2548stats realm X X X X
2549stats refresh X X X X
2550stats scope X X X X
2551stats show-desc X X X X
2552stats show-legends X X X X
2553stats show-node X X X X
2554stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002555-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2556stick match - - X X
2557stick on - - X X
2558stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002559stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002560stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002561tcp-check connect - - X X
2562tcp-check expect - - X X
2563tcp-check send - - X X
2564tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002565tcp-request connection - X X -
2566tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002567tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002568tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002569tcp-response content - - X X
2570tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571timeout check X - X X
2572timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002573timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002574timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2575timeout connect X - X X
2576timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2577timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2578timeout http-request X X X X
2579timeout queue X - X X
2580timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002581timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2583timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002584timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002586unique-id-format X X X -
2587unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002589use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002590------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2591 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025944.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2595---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002596
2597This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2598
2599
2600acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2601 Declare or complete an access list.
2602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2603 no | yes | yes | yes
2604 Example:
2605 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2606 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2607 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610
2611
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002612backlog <conns>
2613 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2615 yes | yes | yes | no
2616 Arguments :
2617 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2618 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002619 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002620
2621 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2622 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2623 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2624 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2625 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2626 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2627 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2628 backlog parameter.
2629
2630 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2631 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2632 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2633
2634 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2635
2636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002638balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 yes | no | yes | yes
2642 Arguments :
2643 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2644 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2645 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2646 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2647
2648 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2649 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2650 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2651 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002653 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002654 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2655 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2656 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2657 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2658 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2659 it, so that you don't worry.
2660
2661 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2662 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2663 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2664 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2665 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2666 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2667 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2668 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002670 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2671 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2672 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2673 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2674 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2675 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2676 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2677 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2678
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002680 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002681 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2682 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002683 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002684 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2685 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2686 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2687 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2688 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002689 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2690 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2691 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2692 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2693 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2694 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2697 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2698 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2699 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2700 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2701 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2702 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2703 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002704 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002706 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2707 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2708 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002710 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2711 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2712 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2713 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2714 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2715 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2716 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2717 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2718 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2719 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2720 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2721 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002723 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002724 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2725 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2726 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2727 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2728 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2729 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2730 URIs start with a leading "/".
2731
2732 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2733 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2734 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2735 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002738 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2739
2740 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002741 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2742 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002743 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2744 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2745 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2746 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002747 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002748 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2749 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002750
2751 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2752 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2753 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2754 server will receive the request.
2755
2756 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2757 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2758 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2759 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2760 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002761 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2762 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2763 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002765 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2766 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2767 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2768 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2769 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002771 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002772 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2773 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2774 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2775
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002776 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2777 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2778 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2779
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002780 random
2781 random(<draws>)
2782 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002783 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2784 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2785 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2786 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002787 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2788 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2789 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2790 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2791 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2792 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2793 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2794 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2795 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2796 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2797 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2798 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2799 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2800 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2801 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2802 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2803 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2804 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2805 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2806 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002807
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002809 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002810 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2811 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2812 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2813 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2814 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2815 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002816 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002817 used instead.
2818
2819 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2820 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2821 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2822 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2823
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002824 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2825 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2826 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2827
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002828 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002831 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2832 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002833
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002834 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2835 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2836 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002839 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002840 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2841 NTLM relies on.
2842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 Examples :
2844 balance roundrobin
2845 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002846 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002847 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2848 balance hdr(host)
2849 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002850
2851 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2852 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002854 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002855 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2856 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2857 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2858 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2859
2860 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2861 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2862 defaults to 16 kB.
2863
2864 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2865 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2866
2867 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2868 Round Robin.
2869
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002870 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002871 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2872 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2873 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2874
2875 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2876
2877 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002878 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002879 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2880 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2881 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002883 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884
2885
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002886bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2887bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2890 no | yes | yes | no
2891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002892 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2893 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2894 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2895 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002896 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002897 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2898 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2899 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2900 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2901 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2902 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2903 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002904 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2905 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2906 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2907 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2908 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2909 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2910 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002911 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2912 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2913 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002914 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2915 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2916 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2917 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002918 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2919 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2920 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002921
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002922 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2923 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002924 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2925 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2926 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002927 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2928 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2929 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2930 the range.
2931
2932 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2933 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2934 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2935 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2936 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2937 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2938 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002939 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002940 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002941
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002943 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002944 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2945 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2946 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2947 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2948 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2949 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002951 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2952 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2953 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2954 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2957 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2958 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2959 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2960 in a frontend.
2961
2962 Example :
2963 listen http_proxy
2964 bind :80,:443
2965 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002966 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002967
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002968 listen http_https_proxy
2969 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002970 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002971
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002972 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2973 bind ipv6@:80
2974 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2975 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2976
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002978 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002979
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002980 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2981 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2982 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2983 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2984 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2985
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002986 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002987 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002988
2989
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002990bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002991 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | yes | yes | yes
2994 Arguments :
2995 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2996 may be used to override a default value.
2997
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002998 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002999 option may be combined with other numbers.
3000
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003001 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003002 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3003 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3004 missing from all processes.
3005
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003007 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003008 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3009 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3010 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3011 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3012 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003013 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003014
3015 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3016 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3017 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3018 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3019 and 'even' instances.
3020
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003021 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3022 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3023 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3024 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003025
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003026 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3027 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3028
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003029 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3030 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3031 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3032
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003033 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3034 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3035
3036 Example :
3037 listen app_ip1
3038 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003039 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003040
3041 listen app_ip2
3042 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003043 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003044
3045 listen management
3046 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003047 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003048
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003049 listen management
3050 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3051 bind-process 1-4
3052
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003053 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003054
3055
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003056block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003057 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 no | yes | yes | yes
3060
3061 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3062 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003063 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003064 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003066 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3067 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3068 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003070 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3071 "http-request deny" instead.
3072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073 Example:
3074 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3075 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3076 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003077 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3078 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3079 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003081 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3082 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3083 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
3085capture cookie <name> len <length>
3086 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 no | yes | yes | no
3089 Arguments :
3090 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3091 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3092 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3093 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003094 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095
3096 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3097 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3098 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3099 right if it exceeds <length>.
3100
3101 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3102 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3103 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3104 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3105
3106 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3107 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3108 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3109
3110 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3111 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3112 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003113 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3114 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3115 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
3117 Example:
3118 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3119
3120 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003121 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
3123
3124capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003125 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 no | yes | yes | no
3128 Arguments :
3129 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003130 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003131 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3132 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3133 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3134
3135 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3136 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3137 it exceeds <length>.
3138
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003139 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3141 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003142 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3143 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3144 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3145 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003146 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003147 environments to find where the request came from.
3148
3149 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3150 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3151 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3152 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003153
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003154 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3155 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3156 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3157 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3158 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159
3160 Example:
3161 capture request header Host len 15
3162 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003163 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003165 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166 about logging.
3167
3168
3169capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003170 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3172 no | yes | yes | no
3173 Arguments :
3174 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003175 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3177 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3178 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3179
3180 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3181 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3182 it exceeds <length>.
3183
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003184 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3186 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3187 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003188 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3189 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3190 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3191 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003193 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3194 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3195 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3196 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3197 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003198
3199 Example:
3200 capture response header Content-length len 9
3201 capture response header Location len 15
3202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003203 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204 about logging.
3205
3206
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003207clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 yes | yes | yes | no
3211 Arguments :
3212 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3214 as explained at the top of this document.
3215
3216 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3217 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3218 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3219 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3220 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3221 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3222 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3223 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003224 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003226 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227
3228 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3229 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3230 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3231 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3232 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3233 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3234
3235 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3236 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3237
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003238 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3239 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003241compression algo <algorithm> ...
3242compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003243compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003244 Enable HTTP compression.
3245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3246 yes | yes | yes | yes
3247 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003248 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3249 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3250 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3251
3252 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003253 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3254 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3255 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003256
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003258 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003259
3260 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3261 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3262 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3263 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3264 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003265 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003266
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003267 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3268 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3269 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3270 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3271 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3272 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3273 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003274 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003276 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003277 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003278 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3279 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3280 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3281 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3282 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003283
3284 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3285 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3286 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3287 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3288 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003289 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3290 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3291 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3292 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3293 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003294 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3295 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003296
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003297 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003298 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3299 "Accept-Encoding" header
3300 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003301 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003302 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3303 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3304 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3305 "multipart"
3306 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3307 header
3308 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3309 and later
3310 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3311 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003312 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003314 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003315
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003316 Examples :
3317 compression algo gzip
3318 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003320
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003321contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3324 yes | no | yes | yes
3325 Arguments :
3326 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3328 as explained at the top of this document.
3329
3330 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003331 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003332 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003333 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003334 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3335 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3336 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3337
3338 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3339 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3340 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3341 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3342 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3343 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3344
3345 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3346 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3347 instead.
3348
3349 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3350 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3351
3352
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003353cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003354 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3355 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003356 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3359 yes | no | yes | yes
3360 Arguments :
3361 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3362 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3363 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3364 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3365 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3366 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003367 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3369 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3370
3371 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3372 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3373 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3374 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3375 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3376 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003377 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3378 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003379 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003380 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3381 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382
3383 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003386 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003388 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003389 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003390 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3391 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3392 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3393 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3394 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3395 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3396 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003397
3398 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3399 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3400 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3401 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3402 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3403 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3404 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3405 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3406 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003407 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003408 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3409 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3410 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003412 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3413 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3414 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003415 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3416 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3417 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3418 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003419 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3420 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3421 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422
3423 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3424 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3425 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3426 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3427 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3428 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3429 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3430 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3431 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3432
3433 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3434 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3435 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3436 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3437 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3438 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3439 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3440 persistence cookie in the cache.
3441 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3442
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003443 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3444 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3445 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3446 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3447 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003448 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003449 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3450 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3451 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3452 they logout.
3453
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003454 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3455 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3456 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3457 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3458
3459 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3460 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3461 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3462 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3463 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3464 this attribute.
3465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003466 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003467 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003468 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3469 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3470 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3471 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3472 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3473 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003474
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003475 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3476 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3477 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3478 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3479 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3480 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3481 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3482 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003483 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003484 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3485 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3486 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3487 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3488 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3489 the site.
3490
3491 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3492 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3493 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3494 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3495 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3496 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3497 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3498 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3499 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3500 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3501 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3502 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3503 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003504 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003505 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3506 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3507
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003508 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3509 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3510 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3511 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3512 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3513 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3514
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003515 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3516 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3517 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3518 repeated.
3519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3521 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3522 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3523 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003525 Examples :
3526 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3528 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003529 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003531 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003532
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003533
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003534declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3535 Declares a capture slot.
3536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 no | yes | yes | no
3538 Arguments:
3539 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3540
3541 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3542 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3543 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3544 for use in the response.
3545
3546 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003547 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003548 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3549
3550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003551default-server [param*]
3552 Change default options for a server in a backend
3553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3554 yes | no | yes | yes
3555 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003556 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3557 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3558 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3559 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003561 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003562 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3563
3564 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003567default_backend <backend>
3568 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3570 yes | yes | yes | no
3571 Arguments :
3572 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3573
3574 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3575 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3576 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3577 will catch all undetermined requests.
3578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 Example :
3580
3581 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3582 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3583 default_backend dynamic
3584
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003585 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003586
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003587
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003588description <string>
3589 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 no | yes | yes | yes
3592 Arguments : string
3593
3594 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3595 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3596 it describes.
3597 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3598
3599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600disabled
3601 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | yes | yes | yes
3604 Arguments : none
3605
3606 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3607 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3608 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3609 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3610 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3611 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3612 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3613
3614 See also : "enabled"
3615
3616
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003617dispatch <address>:<port>
3618 Set a default server address
3619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003622
3623 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3624 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3625 during start-up.
3626
3627 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3628 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3629 possible with normal servers.
3630
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003631 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003632 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3633 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3634 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3635 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3636
3637 See also : "server"
3638
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003639
3640dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3641 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 yes | no | yes | yes
3644 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3645
3646 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003648 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3649 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003650 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003651 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653enabled
3654 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | yes
3657 Arguments : none
3658
3659 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3660 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3661
3662 See also : "disabled"
3663
3664
3665errorfile <code> <file>
3666 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | yes
3669 Arguments :
3670 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +01003671 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502,
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003672 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673
3674 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003675 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003676 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003677 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3678 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679
3680 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3681 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3682 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3683
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003684 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003686 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3687 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3688 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3689 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3690
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3692 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003693 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003694 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3695 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3696 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3697
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003698 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3699 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3700 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003701 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003702 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3703
3704 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3705
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003706 Example :
3707 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003708 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003709 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3710 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003712
3713errorloc <code> <url>
3714errorloc302 <code> <url>
3715 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 yes | yes | yes | yes
3718 Arguments :
3719 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +01003720 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502,
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003721 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003722
3723 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3724 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3725 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3726 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003727 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003728
3729 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3730 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3731 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3732
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003733 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003735 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3736 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3737 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3738 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003739 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003740 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3741 request.
3742
3743 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3744
3745
3746errorloc303 <code> <url>
3747 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Thamc09f7972020-01-08 10:19:05 +01003752 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502,
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003753 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754
3755 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3756 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3757 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3758 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003759 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003760
3761 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3762 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3763 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3764
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003765 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003767 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3768 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3769 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3770 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003771 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003772
3773 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3774
3775
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776email-alert from <emailaddr>
3777 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003778 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 yes | yes | yes | yes
3781
3782 Arguments :
3783
3784 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3785
3786 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3787 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3788
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003789 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003790 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3791 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003792
3793
3794email-alert level <level>
3795 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3796 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | yes | yes | yes
3799
3800 Arguments :
3801
3802 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3803 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3804 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3805
3806 By default level is alert
3807
3808 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3809 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3810 for the proxy.
3811
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003812 Alerts are sent when :
3813
3814 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3815 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3816 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3817 is notice or lower
3818 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3819 and a health check status update occurs
3820
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003821 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3822 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003823 section 3.6 about mailers.
3824
3825
3826email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3827 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | yes | yes | yes
3830
3831 Arguments :
3832
3833 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3834
3835 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3836 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3837
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003838 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3839 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003840
3841
3842email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3843 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3844 mailers.
3845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 yes | yes | yes | yes
3847
3848 Arguments :
3849
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003850 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003851
3852 By default the systems hostname is used.
3853
3854 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3855 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3856 for the proxy.
3857
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003858 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3859 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003860
3861
3862email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003863 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003864 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3866 yes | yes | yes | yes
3867
3868 Arguments :
3869
3870 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3871
3872 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3873 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3874
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003875 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003876 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3877
3878
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003879force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3880 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003882 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003883
3884 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3885 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3886 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3887 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3888 marked down for maintenance operations.
3889
3890 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3891 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3892 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3893 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3894 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3895 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3896 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3897 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3898 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3899
3900 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3901 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3902 is used.
3903
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003904 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003905 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003906
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003907
3908filter <name> [param*]
3909 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 no | yes | yes | yes
3912 Arguments :
3913 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3914 referenced in section 9.
3915
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003918 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3919 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003920
3921 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3922 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3923
3924 Example:
3925 listen
3926 bind *:80
3927
3928 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3929 filter compression
3930 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3931
3932 compression algo gzip
3933 compression offload
3934
3935 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3936
3937 See also : section 9.
3938
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003939
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003940fullconn <conns>
3941 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | no | yes | yes
3944 Arguments :
3945 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3946 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3947
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003950 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003951 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3952 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3953 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3954 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3955 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003956 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003957
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003958 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3959 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003960 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3961 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3962 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003963
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003964 Example :
3965 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3966 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3967 # connections.
3968 backend dynamic
3969 fullconn 10000
3970 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3971 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3972
3973 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3974
3975
3976grace <time>
3977 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003979 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003980 Arguments :
3981 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3982 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3983 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3984
3985 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3986 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003987 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003988 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3989
3990 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3991 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3992 simplify it.
3993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003994
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003995hash-balance-factor <factor>
3996 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3998 yes | no | no | yes
3999 Arguments :
4000 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4001 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004002 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004003
4004 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4005 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4006 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4007 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4008 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4009 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4010 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4011
4012 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4013 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4014 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4015 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4016 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4017
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004018 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4019 consistent hashing mechanism.
4020
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004021 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4022
4023
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004024hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004025 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4027 yes | no | yes | yes
4028 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004029 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4030 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004031
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004032 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4033 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4034 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4035 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4036 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4037 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4038 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4039 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4040 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4041 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004042
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004043 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4044 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4045 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4046 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4047 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4048 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4049 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4050 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4051 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4052 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4053 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4054 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4055 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004056 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4057 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004058
4059 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4060
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004061 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004062 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4063 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4064 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004065 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4066 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4067 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004068
4069 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4070 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004071 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4072 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4073 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4074 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4075
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004076 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4077 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4078 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4079 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4080 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4081 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4082 parameter.
4083
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004084 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4085 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4086 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4087 used on strings.
4088
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004089 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4090
4091 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4092 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4093 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4094 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4095 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4096 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4097 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4098 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4099 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4100 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4101 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4102 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004103
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004104 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4105 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4106 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004108 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004109
4110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004111http-check disable-on-404
4112 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004114 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115 Arguments : none
4116
4117 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4118 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4119 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4120 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4121 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4122 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4123 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4124 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004125 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4126 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4127 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4128
4129 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4130
4131
4132http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004133 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004135 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004136 Arguments :
4137 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4138 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004139 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004140 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4141 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4142 details on the supported keywords.
4143
4144 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4145 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4146 with the usual backslash ('\').
4147
4148 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4149 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4150 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4151 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4152 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4153
4154 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004155 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004156 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4157 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4158 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4159
4160 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004161 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004162 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4163 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4164 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4165 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4166
4167 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004168 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004169 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4170 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4171 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4172 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4173 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004174 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004175 trace).
4176
4177 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004178 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004179 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4180 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4181 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4182 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4183 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004185
4186 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4187 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4188 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4189 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4190 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4191 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4192 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4193 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4194
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004195 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4196 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4197 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4198
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004199 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4200 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4201
4202 Examples :
4203 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004204 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004205
4206 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004207 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004208
4209 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004210 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004211
4212 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004213 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004214
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004215 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004216
4217
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004218http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4219 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4220 health checks.
4221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4222 yes | no | yes | yes
4223 Arguments :
4224 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4225 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4226 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4227
4228 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4229 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4230 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4231 to the request.
4232
4233 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4234 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4235 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4236 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4237 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4238 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4239 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4240 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4241
4242 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4243
4244
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004245http-check send-state
4246 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | no | yes | yes
4249 Arguments : none
4250
4251 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4252 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4253 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4254 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4255 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4256
4257 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4258 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4259 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4260 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4261 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004262 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4263 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4264 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4265
4266 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4267 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4268 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4269
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004270 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4271 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4272 checked in multiple backends.
4273
4274 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4275 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4276
4277 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4278 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4279 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4280 one fails.
4281
4282 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4283 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4284 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4285
4286 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4287 server's queue.
4288
4289 Example of a header received by the application server :
4290 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4291 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4292
4293 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295
4296http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004297 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4298
4299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 no | yes | yes | yes
4301
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004302 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4303 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4304 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4305 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4306 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4309 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4314 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4315 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4316 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4319 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4320 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4321 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004323 Example:
4324 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4325 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4326 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328 http-request allow if nagios
4329 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4330 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4331 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004333 Example:
4334 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4335 acl add path /addacl
4336 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4341 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 Example:
4344 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4345 acl setmap path /setmap
4346 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4351 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4354 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4359 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4360 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4361 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4362 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4363 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4364 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4365 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4370 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4371 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4372 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4373 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4374 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4375 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4376 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4381 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004382
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4387 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4388 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4389 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4390 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 Example:
4393 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4394 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004395
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004396http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4401 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4404 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4405 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4406 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4407 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4408 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4409 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4410 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4411 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4414 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4415 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004416 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4417
4418 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4419 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4420 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4421 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004425 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4426 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4427 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4428 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4429 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4430 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4439 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4440 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4441 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4442 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4443 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4448 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4449 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4450 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4451 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004452
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004453http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4454 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4455 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4456 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4457
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004458http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4459
4460 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4461 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4462 pointed by <resolvers>.
4463 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4464 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4465 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4466 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4467 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4468 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4469 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4470 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4471 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4472 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4473 to 0.0.0.0.
4474
4475 Example:
4476 resolvers mydns
4477 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4478 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4479 timeout retry 1s
4480 hold valid 10s
4481 hold nx 3s
4482 hold other 3s
4483 hold obsolete 0s
4484 accepted_payload_size 8192
4485
4486 frontend fe
4487 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4488 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4489 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4490
4491 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4492 # which mean DNS resolution error
4493 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4494
4495 default_backend be
4496
4497 backend b_503
4498 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4499 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4500 # 503 error page to end users
4501
4502 backend be
4503 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4504 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4505 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4506 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4507 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4508
4509 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4510 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4511
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004512http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4513
4514 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4515 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4516 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4517 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004518 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4519 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004520
4521 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4526 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4527 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4528 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4529 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4534 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4535 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4536 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004540
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004541 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004542 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4543 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4544 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4545 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4546 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004547
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004548 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4549 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4550 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4551 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4552 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004553
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004554 Example:
4555 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4556
4557 # applied to:
4558 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4559
4560 # outputs:
4561 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4562
4563 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004564
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004565 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4566
4567 # applied to:
4568 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004569
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004570 # outputs:
4571 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004572
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004573http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4574 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4575
4576 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4577 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4578 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4579 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4580
4581 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4582 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4583 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4584
4585 Example:
4586 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4587 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4588
4589 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4590 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4591
4592 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4593 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4594 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4595 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4596
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004597http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4598 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4599
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004600 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4601 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4602 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4603 against.
4604
4605 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4606 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4607 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004608
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004609 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4610 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4611 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4612 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4613 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4614 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4615 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4616 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4617 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004618 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4619 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004620
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004621 Example:
4622 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4623 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004624
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004625 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4626 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4629 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004630
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004631 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4632 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4633 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4634 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004635
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004636 Example:
4637 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004638
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004639 # applied to:
4640 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004641
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004642 # outputs:
4643 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4646http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4649 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4650 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4655 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4656 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004660 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4661 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4662 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4663 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4664 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004666 Arguments:
4667 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4668 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004670 Example:
4671 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4672 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4675 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4680 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4681 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004683 Arguments:
4684 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4685 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 Example:
4688 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4689 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4692 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4693 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004695http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004697 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4698 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4699 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4700 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4701 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004703 Example:
4704 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4708 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4709 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4710 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4711 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4712 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4717 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4718 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4719 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4720 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4723 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4726 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4727 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4728 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4729 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4730 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4731 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4732 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4733 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004737 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4738 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4739 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4740 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4741 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4742 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4743 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004745http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004747 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4748 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4749 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004751http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004753 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4754 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4755 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4756 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4757 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4758 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4759 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4760 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004764 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4765 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4766 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4767 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4768 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4769 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771 Example :
4772 # prepend the host name before the path
4773 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004775http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004777 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4778 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4779 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4780 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4781 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004783http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004785 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4786 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4787 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4788 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4789 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4790 values have higher priority.
4791 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4792 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4793 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4794 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4795 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004799 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4800 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4801 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4802 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4803 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4804 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4805 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004807 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004808
4809 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004810 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4811 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004813http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4814 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4815 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4816 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004817 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4818 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004819
4820 Arguments :
4821 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4822 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004823
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004824 See also "option forwardfor".
4825
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004826 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004827 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4828 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4829
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004830 # After the masking this will track connections
4831 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4832 http-request track-sc0 src
4833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004834 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4835 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4836
4837http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4838
4839 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4840 expression.
4841
4842 Arguments:
4843 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4844 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004845
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004846 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004847 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4848 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4849
4850 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4851 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4852 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4853
4854http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4855
4856 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4857 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4858 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4859 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4860 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4861 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4862 information from the request.
4863
4864 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4865
4866http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4867
4868 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4869 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4870 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4871 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4872 path and the query string.
4873 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4874
4875http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4876
4877 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4878 inline.
4879
4880 Arguments:
4881 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4882 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4883 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4884 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4885 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4886 (request and response)
4887 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4888 processing
4889 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4890 processing
4891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4892 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4893 and '_'.
4894
4895 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4896 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004897
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004898 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004901http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4902 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004904 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4905 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4906 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4907 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4908 agent name must be used.
4909
4910 Arguments:
4911 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4912
4913 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4914 configuration.
4915
4916http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4917
4918 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4919 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4920 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4921 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4922 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4923 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4924 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4925 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4926 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4927 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4928 action.
4929 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4930 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4931 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4932 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4933 you fully understand how it works.
4934
4935http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4936
4937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4938 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4939 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4940 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4941 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4942 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4943 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4944 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4945 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4946 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4947 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4948 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4949 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4950
4951http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4952http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4953http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4954
4955 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4956 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4957 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4958 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4959 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4960 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4961 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4962 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4963 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4964 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4965 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4966 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4967
4968 Arguments :
4969 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4970 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4971 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4972 select which table entry to update the counters.
4973
4974 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4975 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4976 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4977 that table until the session ends.
4978
4979 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4980 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4981 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4982 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4983 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4984 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4985 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4986 useful information.
4987
4988 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4989 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4990 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4991 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4992 checks that make use of it.
4993
4994http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4995
4996 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004997
4998 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004999 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005000
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005001http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5002
5003 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5004 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5005 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5006 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5007 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5008 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5009
5010 Arguments :
5011 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5012
5013 Example:
5014 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005016http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005018 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5019 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5020 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005021
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005022
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005023http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005024 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5025
5026 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 no | yes | yes | yes
5028
5029 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5030 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5031 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5032 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5033 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5034 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5037 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5042 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5043 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5044 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5047 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5048 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5049 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051 Example:
5052 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005056 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5057 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 Example:
5060 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5065 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5068 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005072 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5073 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5074 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5075 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5076 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5077 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5078 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5079 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005083 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5084 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5085 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5086 example, or to pass some internal information.
5087 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5088 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5089 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005091http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005093 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5094 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005095
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005096http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5103 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5104 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5105 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5106 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5107 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5108 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005110 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5111 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5112 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5113 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5114 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005115
5116 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5117 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5118 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5119 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005123 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5124 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5125 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5126 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5127 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5128 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005130http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005132 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005134http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005136 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5137 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5138 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5139 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5140 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5141 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5146 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005148http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005150 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5151 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5152 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5153 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5154 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5155 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005157http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5158 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005159
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005160 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5161 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005163 Example:
5164 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005166 # applied to:
5167 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169 # outputs:
5170 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005172 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005174http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5175 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005176
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005177 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5178 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005180 Example:
5181 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005183 # applied to:
5184 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005186 # outputs:
5187 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005189http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5190http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005191
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005192 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5193 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5194 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005196http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005198 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5199 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5200 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005202http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005204 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5205 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5206 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5207 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5208 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005210 Arguments:
5211 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005213 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5214 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005216http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005218 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5219 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5220 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005222http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5223
5224 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5225 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5226 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5227 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5228 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5229
5230http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5231
5232 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5233 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5234 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5235 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5236 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5237 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5238 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5239 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5240 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5241
5242http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5243
5244 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5245 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5246 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5247 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5248 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5249 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5250 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5251
5252http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5253
5254 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5255 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5256 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5257 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5258 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5259 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5260 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5261 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5262
5263http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5264 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5265
5266 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5267 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5268 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5269 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005270
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005271 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005272 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5273 http-response set-status 431
5274 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5275 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005277http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005279 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5280 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5281 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5282 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5283 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5284 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5285 based on some information from the request.
5286
5287 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5288
5289http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5290
5291 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5292 inline.
5293
5294 Arguments:
5295 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5296 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5300 (request and response)
5301 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5302 processing
5303 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5304 processing
5305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5306 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5307 and '_'.
5308
5309 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5310 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005311
5312 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005313 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005315http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005317 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5318 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5319 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5320 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5321 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5322 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5323 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5324 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5325 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5326 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5327 action.
5328 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5329 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5330 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5331 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5332 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005334http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5335http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5336http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005337
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005338 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5339 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5340 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5341 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5342 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5343 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5344
5345http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5346
5347 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5348 about <var-name>.
5349
5350 Example:
5351 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5352
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005353
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005354http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5355 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5356
5357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 yes | no | yes | yes
5359
5360 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005361 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5362 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5363 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005364
5365 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5366
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005367 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5368 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5369 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5370 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5371 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5372 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5373 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5374 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5375 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5376 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005377
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005378 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5379 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5380 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5381 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5382 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5383 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5384 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5385 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005386
5387 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5388 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5389 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5390 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5391 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5392 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5393 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5394 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005395 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005396 downsides of rare connection failures.
5397
5398 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5399 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5400 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5401 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5402 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5403 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005404 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005405 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5406 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5407 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5408 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5409 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5410
5411 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005412 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5413 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5414 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005415
5416 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005417 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005418
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005419 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5420 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005421
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005422 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005423
5424 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5425 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5426 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5427
5428 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5429
5430
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005431http-send-name-header [<header>]
5432 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5434 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005435 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005436 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5437
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005438 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5439 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5440 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5441 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5442 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5443 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5444 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5445 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5446 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5447 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5448 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5449 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5450 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5451 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5452 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5453 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005454
5455 See also : "server"
5456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005457id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005458 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 no | yes | yes | yes
5461 Arguments : none
5462
5463 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5464 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5465 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005466
5467
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005468ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5469 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005471 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005472
5473 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5474 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5475 and running).
5476
5477 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5478 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5479 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005480 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005481 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5482
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005483 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5484 "unless" condition is met.
5485
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005486 Example:
5487 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5488 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5489 ignore-persist if url_static
5490
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005491 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5492
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005493load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5494 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5496 yes | no | yes | yes
5497
5498 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5499 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5500 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005501 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005502 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5503 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5504 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5505 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005508 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005509 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005510
5511 Arguments:
5512 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5513 named "server-state-file".
5514
5515 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5516 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5517 name is used as a file name.
5518
5519 none don't load any stat for this backend
5520
5521 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005522 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5523 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5524 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005525 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005526 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005527
5528 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5529 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5530
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005531 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005533 global
5534 stats socket /tmp/socket
5535 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005536
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005537 defaults
5538 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005539
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005540 backend bk
5541 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5542 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005543
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005544
5545 Then one can run :
5546
5547 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5548
5549 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5550
5551 1
5552 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5553 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5554 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5555
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005556 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005557
5558 global
5559 stats socket /tmp/socket
5560 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5561
5562 defaults
5563 load-server-state-from-file local
5564
5565 backend bk
5566 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5567 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5568
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005569
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005570 Then one can run :
5571
5572 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5573
5574 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5575
5576 1
5577 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5578 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5579 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5580
5581 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5582 "show servers state"
5583
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005585log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005586log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5587 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005588no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005589 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5591 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005592
5593 Prefix :
5594 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5595 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5596 prefix does not allow arguments.
5597
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005598 Arguments :
5599 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5600 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5601 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5602 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5603 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5604 parameter.
5605
5606 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5607 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5608
5609 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5610 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5611 standard syslog port).
5612
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005613 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5614 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5615 standard syslog port).
5616
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005617 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5618 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5619 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005620 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005621
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005622 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5623 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5624 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5625 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5626 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5627 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5628 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5629 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5630 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5631 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5632 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5633 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5634 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5635 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5636 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5637 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005638 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5639 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005640
5641 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5642 and "fd@2", see above.
5643
5644 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5645 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005646
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005647 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5648 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5649 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5650 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5651 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5652 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5653 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5654 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5655 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5656 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005657 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005658
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005659 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5660 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5661 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5662 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5663 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5664
5665 <sample_size>
5666 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5667 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5668 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5669 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5670 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5671
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005672 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5673 one of the following :
5674
5675 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5676 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5677
5678 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5679 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5680
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005681 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5682 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5683 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5684 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5685 systemd logger consumes.
5686
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005687 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5688 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5689 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5690 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5691
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005692 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5693
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005694 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5695 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5696 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5697
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005698 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5699 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5700 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5701 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005702
5703 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5704 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5705 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005706 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5707 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5708 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5709 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5710 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005711
5712 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5713
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005714 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5715 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5716 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005717
5718 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5719 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5720 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5721 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5722
5723 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5724 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005725
5726 Example :
5727 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005728 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5729 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5730 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005731 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5732 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005733 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005736log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005737 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5739 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005740
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005741 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5742 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5743 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5744 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5745 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005746
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005747 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5748 "option httplog" directives.
5749
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005750log-format-sd <string>
5751 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5753 yes | yes | yes | no
5754
5755 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5756 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5757 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5758 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5759 which covers the log format string in depth.
5760
5761 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5762 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5763
5764 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5765 log format to "rfc5424".
5766
5767 Example :
5768 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5769
5770
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005771log-tag <string>
5772 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | yes | yes | yes
5775
5776 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5777 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5778 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5779 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5780 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5781 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5782 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5783 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5784 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005785
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005786max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5787 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | no | yes | yes
5790
5791 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5792 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5793 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5794 servers.
5795
5796 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5797 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5798 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5799 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5800 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005801 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005802 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5803 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5804 picking a different server.
5805
5806 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5807 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5808 even if they have to be queued.
5809
5810 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5811 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5812
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005813max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5814 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5815 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5816 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005817
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005818maxconn <conns>
5819 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 yes | yes | yes | no
5822 Arguments :
5823 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5824 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5825 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5826 closes.
5827
5828 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5829 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5830 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5831 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005832 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5833 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5834 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5835 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005836
5837 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5838 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5839 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5840
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005841 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5842 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005843
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005844 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5845
5846
5847mode { tcp|http|health }
5848 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 yes | yes | yes | yes
5851 Arguments :
5852 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5853 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5854 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5855 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5856
5857 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5858 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5859 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5860 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5861 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5862
5863 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005864 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5865 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5866 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5867 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5868 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5869 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5870 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005871
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005872 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5873 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5874 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005876 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005877 defaults http_instances
5878 mode http
5879
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005880 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005882
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005883monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005884 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005887 Arguments :
5888 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5889 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005890 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005891 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5892 backend and its backup.
5893
5894 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5895 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5896 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5897 servers in a list of backends.
5898
5899 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5900 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5901 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5902 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5903 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5904 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5905 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005906 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5907 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005908
5909 Example:
5910 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005911 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005912 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5913 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5914 monitor-uri /site_alive
5915 monitor fail if site_dead
5916
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005917 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005918
5919
5920monitor-net <source>
5921 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5923 yes | yes | yes | no
5924 Arguments :
5925 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5926 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5927 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5928 followed by a mask.
5929
5930 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5931 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005932 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005933 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5934
5935 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5936 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5937 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5938 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005939 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5940 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5941 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005942
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005943 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5944 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5945 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5946 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5947 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5948 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005949
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005950 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5951 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005952
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005953 Example :
5954 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5955 frontend www
5956 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5957
5958 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5959
5960
5961monitor-uri <uri>
5962 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5964 yes | yes | yes | no
5965 Arguments :
5966 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5967 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5968
5969 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5970 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5971 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5972 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5973 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5974 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5975 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5976 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5977
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005978 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5979 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5980 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5981 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5982 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5983 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5984 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5985 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005986
5987 Example :
5988 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5989 frontend www
5990 mode http
5991 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5992
5993 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005995
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005996option abortonclose
5997no option abortonclose
5998 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6000 yes | no | yes | yes
6001 Arguments : none
6002
6003 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6004 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6005 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6006 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006007 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006008 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6009 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6010 encountered while delivering the response.
6011
6012 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6013 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6014 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6015 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6016 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6017 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006018 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006019 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006020 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006021 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6022 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6023 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6024
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006025 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6026 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006027 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6028 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6029 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6030 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6031 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6032 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006033 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006034
6035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6037
6038 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6039
6040
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006041option accept-invalid-http-request
6042no option accept-invalid-http-request
6043 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | yes | yes | no
6046 Arguments : none
6047
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006048 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006049 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006050 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006051 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6052 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6053 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6054 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6055 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006056 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6057 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6058 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6059 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006060 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006061 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006062 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6063 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6064 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006065
6066 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6067 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6068 been confirmed.
6069
6070 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6071 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006072 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6073 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006074 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6075
6076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6078
6079 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6080 stats socket.
6081
6082
6083option accept-invalid-http-response
6084no option accept-invalid-http-response
6085 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6087 yes | no | yes | yes
6088 Arguments : none
6089
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006090 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006091 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006092 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006093 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6094 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6095 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6096 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6097 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006098 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6099 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6100 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006101
6102 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6103 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6104 been confirmed.
6105
6106 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6107 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6108 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6109 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6110
6111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6113
6114 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6115 stats socket.
6116
6117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118option allbackups
6119no option allbackups
6120 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6122 yes | no | yes | yes
6123 Arguments : none
6124
6125 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6126 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6127 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6128 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6129 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6130 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6131 order between the backup servers anymore.
6132
6133 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6134 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6135
6136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6138
6139
6140option checkcache
6141no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006142 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6144 yes | no | yes | yes
6145 Arguments : none
6146
6147 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6148 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006149 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006150 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6151 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006152 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006153
6154 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006155 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006156 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006157 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6158 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006159 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006160 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006161 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6162 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006163 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006164 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6165 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006166 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006167 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6170 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6171 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6172 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6173 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6174 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6175 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6176
6177 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006178 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006179 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006180 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006181 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6182
6183 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6184 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006185 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006186 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006187
6188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6190
6191
6192option clitcpka
6193no option clitcpka
6194 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6196 yes | yes | yes | no
6197 Arguments : none
6198
6199 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6200 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006201 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006202 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6203
6204 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6205 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6206 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6207 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6208
6209 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6210 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6211 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6212 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6213 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6214
6215 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6216
6217 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6218 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6219 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6220
6221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6223
6224 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6225
6226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006227option contstats
6228 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6230 yes | yes | yes | no
6231 Arguments : none
6232
6233 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6234 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6235 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6236 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006237 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6238 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6239 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6240 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6241 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006242
6243
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006244option dontlog-normal
6245no option dontlog-normal
6246 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6248 yes | yes | yes | no
6249 Arguments : none
6250
6251 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6252 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6253 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6254 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6255 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6256 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6257 logged.
6258
6259 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6260 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6261 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006263 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006264 logging.
6265
6266
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006267option dontlognull
6268no option dontlognull
6269 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6271 yes | yes | yes | no
6272 Arguments : none
6273
6274 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6275 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6276 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6277 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6278 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6279 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006280 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6281 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6282 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006283
6284 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006285 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006286 would not be logged.
6287
6288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6290
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006291 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6292 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006293
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006294
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006295option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006296 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6298 yes | yes | yes | yes
6299 Arguments :
6300 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6301 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006302 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006303 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006304
6305 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6306 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6307 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6308 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6309 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6310 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6311 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006312 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6313 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6314 possible that the client has already brought one.
6315
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006316 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006317 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006318 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006319 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006320 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006321 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006322
6323 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6324 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6325 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6326 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6327 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6328 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6329 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6330
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006331 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6332 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6333 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6334 are under the control of the end-user.
6335
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006336 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006337 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6338 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006339 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6340 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6341 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006342
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006343 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006344 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6345 frontend www
6346 mode http
6347 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6348
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006349 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6350 backend www
6351 mode http
6352 option forwardfor header X-Client
6353
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006354 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006355 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006356
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006357
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006358option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6359no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6360 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6362 yes | yes | yes | no
6363 Arguments : none
6364
6365 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6366 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6367 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6368 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6369 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6370 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6371 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6372
6373 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6374 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6375 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6376 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6377 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6378 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6379 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6380 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6381 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6382 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6383
6384 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6385
6386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6388
6389 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6390 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6391
6392
6393option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6394no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6395 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6397 yes | no | yes | yes
6398 Arguments : none
6399
6400 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6401 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6402 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6403 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6404 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6405 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6406 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6407
6408 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6409 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6410 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6411 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6412 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6413 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6414 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6415 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6416 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6417 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6418
6419 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6420
6421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6423
6424 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6425 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6426
6427
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006428option http-buffer-request
6429no option http-buffer-request
6430 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6432 yes | yes | yes | yes
6433 Arguments : none
6434
6435 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6436 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6437 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6438 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6439 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6440 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6441 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6442 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006443 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006444 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6445 default.
6446
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006447 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006448
6449
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006450option http-ignore-probes
6451no option http-ignore-probes
6452 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | yes | yes | no
6455 Arguments : none
6456
6457 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6458 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6459 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6460 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6461 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6462 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6463 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6464 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6465 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006466 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6467 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006468 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6469
6470 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6471 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6472 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6473 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6474 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6475 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6476 are often the only way to detect them.
6477
6478 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6479 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6480
6481 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6482
6483
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006484option http-keep-alive
6485no option http-keep-alive
6486 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | yes | yes | yes
6489 Arguments : none
6490
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006491 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6492 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006493 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6494 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6495 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6496 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6497 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006498
6499 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6500 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006501 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6502 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6503 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6504 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6505 situations where this option may be useful :
6506
6507 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006508 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006509
6510 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6511 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6512
6513 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6514 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6515 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6516 request.
6517
6518 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6519 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006520 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6521 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6522 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006523
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006524 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6525 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6526 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6527 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6528 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6529 not set.
6530
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006531 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006532 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6533 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006534
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006535 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006536 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006537 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006538
6539
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006540option http-no-delay
6541no option http-no-delay
6542 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 yes | yes | yes | yes
6545 Arguments : none
6546
6547 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6548 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6549 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6550 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6551 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6552 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6553 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6554 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6555 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6556 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6557 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6558 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6559 affected.
6560
6561 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6562 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6563 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6564 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6565 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6566 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6567 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6568 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6569 latency environments.
6570
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006571 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6572
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006573
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006574option http-pretend-keepalive
6575no option http-pretend-keepalive
6576 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006578 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006579 Arguments : none
6580
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006581 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006582 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6583 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6584 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6585 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6586 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6587 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6588 consider the response complete.
6589
6590 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6591 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6592 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6593 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006594 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006595 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6596
6597 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6598 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6599 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6600 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6601 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6602 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6603 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6604
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006605 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6606 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6607 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6608 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6609 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6610 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006611
6612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6614
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006615 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006616 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006617
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006618
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006619option http-server-close
6620no option http-server-close
6621 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 yes | yes | yes | yes
6624 Arguments : none
6625
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006626 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6627 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6628 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6629 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006630 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6631 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6632 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6633 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6634 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6635 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6636 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6637 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6638 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6639 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6640 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006641
6642 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6643 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6644 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6645 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006646 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6647 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006648
6649 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6650 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006651 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6652 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6653 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006654
6655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6657
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006658 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6659 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006660
6661
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006662option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6663no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6664 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006666 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006667 Arguments : none
6668
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006669 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6670 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6671 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6672
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006673 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6674 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6675 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6676 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006677 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006678
6679 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006680 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006681 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6682 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6683 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6684 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6685 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6686 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6687 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006688
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006689 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6690 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6691 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6692 backend.
6693
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6696
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006697 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6698 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006699
6700
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006701option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006702no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006703 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6705 yes | yes | yes | no
6706 Arguments : none
6707
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006708 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006709 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6710 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6711 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6712 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6713 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6714 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6715
6716 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6717 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006718 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6719 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6720 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006721
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006722 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6723 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6724 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6725 front of an existing proxy.
6726
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006727 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6728
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006729 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006730
6731
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006732option http-use-htx
6733no option http-use-htx
6734 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | yes | yes | yes
6737 Arguments : none
6738
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006739 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006740 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006741 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6742 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6743 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6744 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6745 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006746
6747 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6748 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6749 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6750 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006751 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6752 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6753 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6754 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006755
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006756 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6757 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6758 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6759 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6760 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006761
6762 See also : "mode http"
6763
6764
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006765option httpchk
6766option httpchk <uri>
6767option httpchk <method> <uri>
6768option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6769 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6771 yes | no | yes | yes
6772 Arguments :
6773 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6774 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6775 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6776 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6777 ones.
6778
6779 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6780 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6781 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6782
6783 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6784 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6785 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006786 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006787
6788 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6789 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6790 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6791 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6792 the lack of any response.
6793
6794 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6795
6796 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6797 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6798 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6799
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006800 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6801 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6802 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6803 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006805 Examples :
6806 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6807 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6808 backend https_relay
6809 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006810 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6811 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006812 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6813
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006814 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6815 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6816 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006817
6818
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006819option httpclose
6820no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006821 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6823 yes | yes | yes | yes
6824 Arguments : none
6825
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006826 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6827 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6828 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6829 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006830 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006831
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006832 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6833 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006834 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006835 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6836 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006837
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006838 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6839 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6840 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006841
6842 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6843 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006844 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006845 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6846 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6847 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006848
6849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6851
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006852 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006853
6854
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006855option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006856 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006858 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006859 Arguments :
6860 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6861 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6862 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006863 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006864 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006865
6866 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6867 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6868 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6869 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6870 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6871 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6872 ports.
6873
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006874 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6875 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006876
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006877 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006879 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006880
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006881
6882option http_proxy
6883no option http_proxy
6884 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6886 yes | yes | yes | yes
6887 Arguments : none
6888
6889 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6890 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6891 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6892 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6893 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6894
6895 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6896 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006897 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6898 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006899
6900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6902
6903 Example :
6904 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6905 backend direct_forward
6906 option httpclose
6907 option http_proxy
6908
6909 See also : "option httpclose"
6910
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006911
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006912option independent-streams
6913no option independent-streams
6914 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6916 yes | yes | yes | yes
6917 Arguments : none
6918
6919 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6920 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6921 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6922 receive data or not.
6923
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006924 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006925 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6926 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6927 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6928 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6929 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6930 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6931 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6932 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6933 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6934 socket buffers.
6935
6936 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6937 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6938 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6939 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6940 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6941
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006942 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006943 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6944 deprecated.
6945
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006946 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006947
6948
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006949option ldap-check
6950 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | no | yes | yes
6953 Arguments : none
6954
6955 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6956 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6957 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6958 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6959
6960 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6961 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6962
6963 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6964 configure it.
6965
6966 Example :
6967 option ldap-check
6968
6969 See also : "option httpchk"
6970
6971
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006972option external-check
6973 Use external processes for server health checks
6974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6975 yes | no | yes | yes
6976
6977 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6978 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6979 command".
6980
6981 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6982
6983 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6984
6985
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006986option log-health-checks
6987no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006988 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006993 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6994 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6995 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006996
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006997 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6998 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6999 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7000 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7001 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007003 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007004 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007005
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007006 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7007 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7008 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007009
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007010
7011option log-separate-errors
7012no option log-separate-errors
7013 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 yes | yes | yes | no
7016 Arguments : none
7017
7018 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7019 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7020 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7021 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7022 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7023 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7024 provides very important information.
7025
7026 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7027 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7028 error logs.
7029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007030 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007031 logging.
7032
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007033
7034option logasap
7035no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007036 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 yes | yes | yes | no
7039 Arguments : none
7040
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007041 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7042 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7043 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7044 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7045
7046 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7047 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7048 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7049 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7050 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7051 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7052 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7053 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7054 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7055 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7056 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007057
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007058 Examples :
7059 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7060 mode http
7061 option httplog
7062 option logasap
7063 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7064
7065 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7066 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7067 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7068 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007070 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007071 logging.
7072
7073
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007074option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007075 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7077 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007078 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007079 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7080 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007081 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007082
7083 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7084 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007085 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007086 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7087 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7088 in the MySQL table, like this :
7089
7090 USE mysql;
7091 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7092 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7093
7094 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007095 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007096 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7097 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7098 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7099 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7100 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7101 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7102 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7103
7104 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7105 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007106
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007107 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007108
7109 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7110 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7111 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7112 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007113 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7114 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007115
7116 See also: "option httpchk"
7117
7118
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007119option nolinger
7120no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007121 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007122 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007124 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007125
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007126 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007127 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7128 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7129 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7130 connections.
7131
7132 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7133 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7134 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7135 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7136 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7137 this too.
7138
7139 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7140 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7141 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7142
7143 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7144 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7145 for servers.
7146
7147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7149
7150
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007151option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7152 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7154 yes | yes | yes | yes
7155 Arguments :
7156 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7157 matching <network>
7158 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7159 header name.
7160
7161 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7162 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7163 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7164 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7165 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7166 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7167 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7168 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7169 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7170 possible that the client has already brought one.
7171
7172 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7173 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7174 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7175 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7176 header and requires different one.
7177
7178 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7179 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7180 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7181 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7182 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7183 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7184 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7185
7186 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7187 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7188 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7189 both are defined.
7190
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007191 Examples :
7192 # Original Destination address
7193 frontend www
7194 mode http
7195 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7196
7197 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7198 backend www
7199 mode http
7200 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7201
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007202 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007203
7204
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007205option persist
7206no option persist
7207 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7209 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007210 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007211
7212 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7213 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7214 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7215 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7216 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7217 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7218 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7219 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7220 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7221 redirected to another valid server.
7222
7223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7225
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007226 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007227
7228
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007229option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7230 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | no | yes | yes
7233 Arguments :
7234 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7235 PostgreSQL server.
7236
7237 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7238 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7239 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7240 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7241
7242 See also: "option httpchk"
7243
7244
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007245option prefer-last-server
7246no option prefer-last-server
7247 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7249 yes | no | yes | yes
7250 Arguments : none
7251
7252 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7253 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7254 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7255 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7256 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7257 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7258 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7259 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7260 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007261 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7262 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007263 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7264 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7265 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007266 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7267 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7268 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007269
7270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7272
7273 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7274
7275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007276option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007277option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007278no option redispatch
7279 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7281 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007282 Arguments :
7283 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7284 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7285 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007286 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007287 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007288 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007289 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7290 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7291 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007293
7294 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7295 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7296 be able to access the service anymore.
7297
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007298 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7299 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007300
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007301 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007302 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7303 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007305 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7306 "redisp" keywords.
7307
7308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7310
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007311 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007312
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007313
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007314option redis-check
7315 Use redis health checks for server testing
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | no | yes | yes
7318 Arguments : none
7319
7320 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7321 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7322 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7323 find the "+PONG" response message.
7324
7325 Example :
7326 option redis-check
7327
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007328 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007329
7330
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007331option smtpchk
7332option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7333 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7335 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007336 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007337 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007338 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007339 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7340
7341 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7342 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7343 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7344
7345 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7346 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7347 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7348 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7349 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7350 dead server.
7351
7352 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7353 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007354 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007355 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7356
7357 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7358 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7359 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7360 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007361 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007362
7363 Example :
7364 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7365
7366 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007369option socket-stats
7370no option socket-stats
7371
7372 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | yes | yes | no
7375
7376 Arguments : none
7377
7378
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007379option splice-auto
7380no option splice-auto
7381 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7383 yes | yes | yes | yes
7384 Arguments : none
7385
7386 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7387 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007389 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007390 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007391 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7392 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7393 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7394 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7395
7396 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7397 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7398 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7399 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7400 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7401 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7402 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7403 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7404 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7405 keyword.
7406
7407 Example :
7408 option splice-auto
7409
7410 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7411 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7412
7413 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7414 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7415
7416
7417option splice-request
7418no option splice-request
7419 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 yes | yes | yes | yes
7422 Arguments : none
7423
7424 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007425 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007426 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7427 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7428 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7429 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7430
7431 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7432
7433 Example :
7434 option splice-request
7435
7436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7438
7439 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7440 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7441
7442
7443option splice-response
7444no option splice-response
7445 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7447 yes | yes | yes | yes
7448 Arguments : none
7449
7450 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007451 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007452 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7453 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7454 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7455 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7456
7457 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7458
7459 Example :
7460 option splice-response
7461
7462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7464
7465 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7466 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7467
7468
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007469option spop-check
7470 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 no | no | no | yes
7473 Arguments : none
7474
7475 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7476 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7477 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7478 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7479
7480 Example :
7481 option spop-check
7482
7483 See also : "option httpchk"
7484
7485
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007486option srvtcpka
7487no option srvtcpka
7488 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7490 yes | no | yes | yes
7491 Arguments : none
7492
7493 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7494 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007495 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007496 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7497
7498 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7499 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7500 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7501 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7502
7503 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7504 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7505 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7506 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7507 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7508
7509 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7510
7511 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7512 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7513 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7514
7515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7517
7518 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7519
7520
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007521option ssl-hello-chk
7522 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7524 yes | no | yes | yes
7525 Arguments : none
7526
7527 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7528 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7529 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7530 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7531 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7532 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7533 hello message.
7534
7535 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7536 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7537 messages, which is appreciable.
7538
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007539 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7540 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7541 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007542
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007543 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7544
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007545
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007546option tcp-check
7547 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7549 yes | no | yes | yes
7550
7551 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7552 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7553
7554 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7555 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7556 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7557
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007558 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007559 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7560 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7561 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7562 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7563 only.
7564
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007565 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007566 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7567 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7568 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7569 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7570
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007571 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007572 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7573 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007574 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007575 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7576 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7577 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7578 the respective protocols.
7579 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007580 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007581
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007582 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7583 script.
7584
7585 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7586 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7587 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7588 The "comment" is of course optional.
7589
7590
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007591 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007592 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007593 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007594 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007596 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007597 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007598 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007599
7600 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7601 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007602 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007603 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007604 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007605 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007606 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007607 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007608 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7609 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007610 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007611 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7612 tcp-check expect string +OK
7613
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007614 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007615 (send many headers before analyzing)
7616 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007617 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007618 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7619 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7620 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7621 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007622 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007623
7624
7625 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7626
7627
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007628option tcp-smart-accept
7629no option tcp-smart-accept
7630 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7632 yes | yes | yes | no
7633 Arguments : none
7634
7635 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7636 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7637 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7638 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7639 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7640 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7641
7642 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7643 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7644 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7645 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7646
7647 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7648 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7649 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007650 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007651
7652 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7653 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7654 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7655
7656 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7657 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7658 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7659
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007660 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7661
7662
7663option tcp-smart-connect
7664no option tcp-smart-connect
7665 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7667 yes | no | yes | yes
7668 Arguments : none
7669
7670 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7671 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7672 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7673 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7674 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7675
7676 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7677 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7678 complex.
7679
7680 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7681 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7682 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7683
7684 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7685 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7686
7687 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7688
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007689
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007690option tcpka
7691 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7693 yes | yes | yes | yes
7694 Arguments : none
7695
7696 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7697 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007698 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007699 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7700
7701 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7702 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7703 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7704 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7705
7706 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7707 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7708 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7709 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7710 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7711
7712 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7713
7714 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7715 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7716 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7717 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7718 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7719 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7720 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7721 backends.
7722
7723 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7724
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007725
7726option tcplog
7727 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007729 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007730 Arguments : none
7731
7732 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7733 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7734 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7735 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7736 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7737 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7738 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7739 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7740
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007741 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007743 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007744
7745
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007746option transparent
7747no option transparent
7748 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007750 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007751 Arguments : none
7752
7753 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7754 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7755 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7756 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7757 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7758 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7759 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7760 appropriate server.
7761
7762 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7763 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7764
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007765 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007766 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007767
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007768
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007769external-check command <command>
7770 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7772 yes | no | yes | yes
7773
7774 Arguments :
7775 <command> is the external command to run
7776
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007777 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7778
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007779 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007780
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007781 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7782 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7783 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7784 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7785 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7786 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007787
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007788 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7789
7790 Environment variables :
7791 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7792 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7793
7794 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7795
7796 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7797
7798 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7799 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7800 for a UNIX socket).
7801
7802 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7803
7804 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7805
7806 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7807
7808 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7809
7810 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7811
7812 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7813 socket).
7814
7815 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7816 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7817
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007818 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7819
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007820 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7821 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7822 failed.
7823
7824 Example :
7825 external-check command /bin/true
7826
7827 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7828
7829
7830external-check path <path>
7831 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7833 yes | no | yes | yes
7834
7835 Arguments :
7836 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7837
7838 The default path is "".
7839
7840 Example :
7841 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7842
7843 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7844 "external-check command"
7845
7846
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007847persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007848persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007849 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7851 yes | no | yes | yes
7852 Arguments :
7853 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007854 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7855 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007856
7857 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7858 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007859 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007860 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7861 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7862 forwarded to this server.
7863
7864 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7865 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7866 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007867 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007868 a single "listen" section.
7869
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007870 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7871 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7872 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7873
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007874 Example :
7875 listen tse-farm
7876 bind :3389
7877 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7878 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7879 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7880 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7881 persist rdp-cookie
7882 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007883 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007884 balance rdp-cookie
7885 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7886 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7887
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007888 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7889 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007890
7891
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007892rate-limit sessions <rate>
7893 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7895 yes | yes | yes | no
7896 Arguments :
7897 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7898 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7899
7900 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7901 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7902 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7903 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7904 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7905 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7906
7907 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7908 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7909 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7910 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7911
7912 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7913 listen smtp
7914 mode tcp
7915 bind :25
7916 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007917 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007918
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007919 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7920 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7921 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007922
7923 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7924
7925
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007926redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7927redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7928redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007929 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7931 no | yes | yes | yes
7932
7933 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007934 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007935
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007936 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007937 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007938 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7939 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7940 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007941
7942 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7943 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7944 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7945 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7946 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007947 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7948 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7949 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7950 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007951
7952 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7953 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7954 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7955 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7956 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7957 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007958 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007959 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007960 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7961 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7962 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007963
7964 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007965 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7966 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7967 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007968 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007969 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7970 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7971 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7972 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007973
7974 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007975 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007976
7977 - "drop-query"
7978 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7979 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7980 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7981 with a location-type redirect.
7982
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007983 - "append-slash"
7984 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7985 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7986 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7987 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7988
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007989 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7990 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7991 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7992 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7993 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7994 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7995 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7996
7997 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7998 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7999 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8000 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8001 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8002 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8003 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008004
8005 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8006 acl clear dst_port 80
8007 acl secure dst_port 8080
8008 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008009 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008010 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008011 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8012
8013 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008014 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8015 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8016 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008017 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008018
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008019 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8020 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8021 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8022
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008023 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008024 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008025
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008026 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008027 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8028 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8029 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008031 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008032
8033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008034redisp (deprecated)
8035redispatch (deprecated)
8036 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008039 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008040
8041 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8042 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8043 be able to access the service anymore.
8044
8045 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8046 redistribute them to a working server.
8047
8048 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8049 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8050 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008052 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8053 "option redispatch" instead.
8054
8055 See also : "option redispatch"
8056
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008057
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008058reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008059 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8061 no | yes | yes | yes
8062 Arguments :
8063 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8064 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008065 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008066
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008067 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8068 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8069
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008070 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8071 the last header of an HTTP request.
8072
8073 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8074 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8075 responses.
8076
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008077 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8078 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8079 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8080
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008081 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8082 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008083
8084
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008085reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8086reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008087 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8089 no | yes | yes | yes
8090 Arguments :
8091 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8092 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8093 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8094 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8095 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8096 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8097 ignores case.
8098
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008099 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8100 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8101
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008102 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8103 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8104 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8105 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008106 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008107
8108 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8109 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8110
8111 Example :
8112 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8113 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8114 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8115
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008116 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8117 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008118
8119
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008120reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8121reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008122 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 no | yes | yes | yes
8125 Arguments :
8126 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8127 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8128 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8129 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8130 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8131 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8132
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008133 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8134 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8135
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008136 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8137 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8138 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8139 next servers.
8140
8141 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8142 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8143 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8144
8145 Example :
8146 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8147 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8148 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8149
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008150 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8151 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008152
8153
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008154reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8155reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008156 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 no | yes | yes | yes
8159 Arguments :
8160 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8161 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8162 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8163 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8164 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8165 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8166 case.
8167
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008168 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8169 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8170
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008171 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8172 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8173 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8174 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008175 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008176
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008177 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008178 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008179 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008180
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008181 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8182 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8183
8184 Example :
8185 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8186 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8187 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8188
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008189 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8190 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008191
8192
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008193reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8194reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008195 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8197 no | yes | yes | yes
8198 Arguments :
8199 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8200 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8201 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8202 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8203 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8204 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8205 case.
8206
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008207 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8208 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8209
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008210 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8211 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8212 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8213 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8214
8215 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8216 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8217
8218 Example :
8219 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8220 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8221 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8222 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8223
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008224 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8225 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008226
8227
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008228reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8229reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008230 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8232 no | yes | yes | yes
8233 Arguments :
8234 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8235 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8236 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8237 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8238 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8239 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8240
8241 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8242 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8243 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8244 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008245 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008246
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008247 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8248 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8249
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008250 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8251 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8252 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8253
8254 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8255 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8256 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8257 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8258 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8259
8260 Example :
8261 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008262 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008263 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8264 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8265
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008266 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8267 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008268
8269
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008270reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8271reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008272 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8274 no | yes | yes | yes
8275 Arguments :
8276 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8277 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8278 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8279 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8280 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8281 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8282 ignores case.
8283
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008284 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8285 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8286
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008287 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8288 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008289 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8290 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8291 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008292 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8293 not set.
8294
8295 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8296 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8297 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8298 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8299 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8300
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008301 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008302 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008303 # block all others.
8304 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8305 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8306
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008307 # block bad guys
8308 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8309 reqitarpit . if badguys
8310
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008311 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8312 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008313
8314
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008315retries <value>
8316 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8318 yes | no | yes | yes
8319 Arguments :
8320 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8321 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8322 default value is 3.
8323
8324 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8325 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8326 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8327
8328 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008329 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8330 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008331
8332 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8333 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8334
8335 See also : "option redispatch"
8336
8337
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008338retry-on [list of keywords]
8339 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | no | yes | yes
8342 Arguments :
8343 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8344 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8345 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8346 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8347
8348 none never retry
8349
8350 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8351 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8352
8353 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8354 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8355 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8356 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8357 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8358 processing the request.
8359
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008360 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8361 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8362 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8363 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8364 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8365 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8366 overflow attack for example).
8367
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008368 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8369 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8370 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8371 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8372 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8373 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8374 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8375 amplify denial of service attacks.
8376
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008377 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8378 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8379 considered to be safe to retry.
8380
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008381 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8382 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8383 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8384 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8385
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008386 all-retryable-errors
8387 retry request for any error that are considered
8388 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8389 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8390 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8391
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008392 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8393 not cumulative.
8394
8395 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8396 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8397 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8398 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8399
8400 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8401 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8402 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8403 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8404 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8405 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8406 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8407 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8408 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8409 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8410 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8411 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8412
8413 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8414 should not use this directive.
8415
8416 The default is "conn-failure".
8417
8418 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8419
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008420rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008421 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8423 no | yes | yes | yes
8424 Arguments :
8425 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8426 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008427 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008428
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008429 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8430 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8431
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008432 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8433 the last header of an HTTP response.
8434
8435 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8436 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8437 responses.
8438
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008439 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8440 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008441
8442
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008443rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8444rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008445 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 no | yes | yes | yes
8448 Arguments :
8449 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8450 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8451 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8452 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8453 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8454 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8455 ignores case.
8456
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008457 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8458 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8459
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008460 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8461 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008462 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008463 client.
8464
8465 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8466 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8467 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8468
8469 Example :
8470 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008471 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008472
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008473 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8474 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008475
8476
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008477rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8478rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008479 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 no | yes | yes | yes
8482 Arguments :
8483 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8484 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8485 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8486 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8487 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8488 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8489 ignores case.
8490
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008491 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8492 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008494 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8495 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8496 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8497 case-sensitive.
8498
8499 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008500 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8501 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8502 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008503
8504 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8505 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8506
8507 Example :
8508 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8509 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8510
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008511 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8512 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008513
8514
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008515rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8516rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008517 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8519 no | yes | yes | yes
8520 Arguments :
8521 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8522 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8523 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8524 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8525 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8526 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8527 ignores case.
8528
8529 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8530 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8531 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8532 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008533 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008534
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008535 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8536 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8537
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008538 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8539 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8540 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8541
8542 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8543 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8544 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8545 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8546 are not case-sensitive.
8547
8548 Example :
8549 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8550 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8551
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008552 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8553 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008554
8555
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008556server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008557 Declare a server in a backend
8558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8559 no | no | yes | yes
8560 Arguments :
8561 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008562 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008563 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008564
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008565 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8566 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8567 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8568 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008569 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8570 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8571 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8572 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8573 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008574 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8575 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8576 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8577 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8578 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8579 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8580 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008581 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008582 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8583 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8584 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8585 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8586 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8587 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008588 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8589 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008590 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8591 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008592
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008593 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008594 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8595 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8596 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8597 adding this value to the client's port.
8598
8599 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8600 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008601 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008602
8603 Examples :
8604 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8605 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008606 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008607 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8608 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8609 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008610
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008611 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8612 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8613 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8614 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8615 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8616
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008617 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8618 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008619
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008620server-state-file-name [<file>]
8621 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8622 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8623 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8624 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8625 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8626 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8627
8628 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8629 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8630
8631 global
8632 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8633
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008634 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008635 load-server-state-from-file
8636
8637 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8638 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008639
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008640server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8641 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8642 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8644 no | no | yes | yes
8645
8646 Arguments:
8647 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8648
8649 <num | range>
8650 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8651 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8652 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8653 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8654
8655 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8656
8657 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8658
8659 <params*>
8660 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8661 keyword.
8662
8663 Examples:
8664 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8665 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8666 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8667
8668 # or
8669 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8670
8671 # would be equivalent to:
8672 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8673 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8674 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8675
8676
8677
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008678source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008679source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008680source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008681 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8683 yes | no | yes | yes
8684 Arguments :
8685 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8686 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008687
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008688 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008689 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8690 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8691 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8692 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8693 supported prefixes are :
8694 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8695 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8696 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008697 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008698 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8699 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008700
8701 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8702 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008703 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8704 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8705 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008706
8707 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8708 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8709 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8710 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8711 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8712 <addr>.
8713
8714 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8715 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8716 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8717 port.
8718
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008719 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8720 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8721 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8722 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008723 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008724 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8725 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8726 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8727 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8728 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8729 HTTP header.
8730
8731 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8732 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008733 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008734 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8735 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8736 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8737 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8738 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8739 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8740 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8741
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008742 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8743 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8744 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8745 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8746 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8747 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8748
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008749 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8750 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8751 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8752 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8753
8754 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8755 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8756 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8757 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8758 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8759 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8760
8761 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8762 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8763 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8764 there are two methods :
8765
8766 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8767 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8768 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8769 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8770 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8771 of the client ranges may be used.
8772
8773 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8774 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8775 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8776 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8777 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8778 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8779 same session.
8780
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008781 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8782 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8783 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008785
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008786 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8787
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008788 Examples :
8789 backend private
8790 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8791 source 192.168.1.200
8792
8793 backend transparent_ssl1
8794 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8795 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8796
8797 backend transparent_ssl2
8798 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8799 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8800 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8801
8802 backend transparent_ssl3
8803 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8804 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8805 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8806
8807 backend transparent_smtp
8808 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8809 # with Tproxy version 4.
8810 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8811
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008812 backend transparent_http
8813 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8814 # proxy.
8815 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008817 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008818 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008820
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008821srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8822 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 yes | no | yes | yes
8825 Arguments :
8826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8828 as explained at the top of this document.
8829
8830 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8831 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8832 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8833 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8834 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8835 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8836 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8837
8838 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8839 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8840 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8841 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8842 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008843 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008844 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008845 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008846
8847 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8851 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8853
8854 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8855 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8856
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008857 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8858 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008859
8860
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008861stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8862 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008864 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008865
8866 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8867 matched.
8868
8869 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8870 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8871
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008872 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8873 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008874 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008875
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008876 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8877 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8878 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8879 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008880
8881 Example :
8882 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8883 backend stats_localhost
8884 stats enable
8885 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8886
8887 Example :
8888 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8889 backend stats_auth
8890 stats enable
8891 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8892 stats admin if TRUE
8893
8894 Example :
8895 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8896 userlist stats-auth
8897 group admin users admin
8898 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8899 group readonly users haproxy
8900 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8901
8902 backend stats_auth
8903 stats enable
8904 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8905 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8906 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8907 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8908
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008909 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8910 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8911 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008912
8913
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008914stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8915 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008917 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008918 Arguments :
8919 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8920
8921 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8922
8923 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8924 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8925 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8926 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8927 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8928 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8929
8930 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8931 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8932 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008933 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008934
8935 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8936 report using "stats scope".
8937
8938 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8939 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8940 unobvious parameters.
8941
8942 Example :
8943 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8944 backend public_www
8945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8946 stats enable
8947 stats hide-version
8948 stats scope .
8949 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008950 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008951 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8952 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8953
8954 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8955 backend private_monitoring
8956 stats enable
8957 stats uri /admin?stats
8958 stats refresh 5s
8959
8960 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8961
8962
8963stats enable
8964 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008966 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008967 Arguments : none
8968
8969 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8970 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8971 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8972 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8973 - stats auth : no authentication
8974 - stats scope : no restriction
8975
8976 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8977 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8978 unobvious parameters.
8979
8980 Example :
8981 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8982 backend public_www
8983 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8984 stats enable
8985 stats hide-version
8986 stats scope .
8987 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008988 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008989 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8990 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8991
8992 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8993 backend private_monitoring
8994 stats enable
8995 stats uri /admin?stats
8996 stats refresh 5s
8997
8998 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8999
9000
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009001stats hide-version
9002 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009004 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009005 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009007 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9008 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9009 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9010 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9011 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9012 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009014 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9015 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9016 unobvious parameters.
9017
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009018 Example :
9019 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9020 backend public_www
9021 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009022 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009023 stats hide-version
9024 stats scope .
9025 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009026 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009027 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9028 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009029
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009030 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9031 backend private_monitoring
9032 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009033 stats uri /admin?stats
9034 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009035
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009036 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009037
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009038
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009039stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9040 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9041 Access control for statistics
9042
9043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9044 no | no | yes | yes
9045
9046 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9047 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9048 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9049 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9050 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9051 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9052
9053 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9054 instance.
9055
9056 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9057 about ACL usage.
9058
9059
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009060stats realm <realm>
9061 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009063 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009064 Arguments :
9065 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9066 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9067 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9068
9069 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9070 using a backslash ('\').
9071
9072 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9073 only related to authentication.
9074
9075 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9076 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9077 unobvious parameters.
9078
9079 Example :
9080 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9081 backend public_www
9082 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9083 stats enable
9084 stats hide-version
9085 stats scope .
9086 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009087 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009088 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9089 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9090
9091 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9092 backend private_monitoring
9093 stats enable
9094 stats uri /admin?stats
9095 stats refresh 5s
9096
9097 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9098
9099
9100stats refresh <delay>
9101 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009103 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009104 Arguments :
9105 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9106 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9107 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9108 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9109 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9110 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9111
9112 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9113 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9114 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9115 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9116
9117 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9118 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9119 unobvious parameters.
9120
9121 Example :
9122 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9123 backend public_www
9124 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9125 stats enable
9126 stats hide-version
9127 stats scope .
9128 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009129 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009130 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9131 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9132
9133 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9134 backend private_monitoring
9135 stats enable
9136 stats uri /admin?stats
9137 stats refresh 5s
9138
9139 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9140
9141
9142stats scope { <name> | "." }
9143 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009145 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009146 Arguments :
9147 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9148 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9149 section in which the statement appears.
9150
9151 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9152 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9153 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9154 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9155 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9156 exists.
9157
9158 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9159 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9160 unobvious parameters.
9161
9162 Example :
9163 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9164 backend public_www
9165 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9166 stats enable
9167 stats hide-version
9168 stats scope .
9169 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009170 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009171 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9172 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9173
9174 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9175 backend private_monitoring
9176 stats enable
9177 stats uri /admin?stats
9178 stats refresh 5s
9179
9180 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9181
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009182
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009183stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009184 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009186 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009187
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009188 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009189 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9190
9191 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9192 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9193
9194 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9195 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009196 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009197
9198 Example :
9199 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9200 backend private_monitoring
9201 stats enable
9202 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9203 stats uri /admin?stats
9204 stats refresh 5s
9205
9206 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9207 global section.
9208
9209
9210stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009211 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9213 yes | yes | yes | yes
9214 Arguments : none
9215
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009216 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009217 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9218 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9219 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9220 - IP (socket, server)
9221 - cookie (backend, server)
9222
9223 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9224 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009225 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009226
9227 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9228
9229
9230stats show-node [ <name> ]
9231 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009233 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009234 Arguments:
9235 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9236 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9237
9238 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9239 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009240 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009241
9242 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9243 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9244 unobvious parameters.
9245
9246 Example:
9247 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9248 backend private_monitoring
9249 stats enable
9250 stats show-node Europe-1
9251 stats uri /admin?stats
9252 stats refresh 5s
9253
9254 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9255 section.
9256
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009257
9258stats uri <prefix>
9259 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009262 Arguments :
9263 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9264 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9265 query string.
9266
9267 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9268 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9269 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9270 possible to reach it in the application.
9271
9272 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009273 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009274 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9275 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9276 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9277 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9278
9279 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9280 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9281 an address or a port to statistics only.
9282
9283 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9284 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9285 unobvious parameters.
9286
9287 Example :
9288 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9289 backend public_www
9290 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9291 stats enable
9292 stats hide-version
9293 stats scope .
9294 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009295 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009296 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9297 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9298
9299 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9300 backend private_monitoring
9301 stats enable
9302 stats uri /admin?stats
9303 stats refresh 5s
9304
9305 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9306
9307
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009308stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9309 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009311 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009312
9313 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009314 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009315 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009316 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009317 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9318
9319 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9320 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9321 the "stick-table" statement.
9322
9323 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9324 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9325 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9326 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9327 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9328
9329 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9330 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9331 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9332 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9333 transformation rules.
9334
9335 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9336 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9337 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9338 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9339 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9340 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9341 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9342
9343 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9344 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9345 ACL based conditions.
9346
9347 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9348 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9349 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9350 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9351
9352 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9353 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9354 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9355 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9356
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009357 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9358 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009359 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009360
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009361 Example :
9362 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9363 # last 30 minutes
9364 backend pop
9365 mode tcp
9366 balance roundrobin
9367 stick store-request src
9368 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9369 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9370 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9371
9372 backend smtp
9373 mode tcp
9374 balance roundrobin
9375 stick match src table pop
9376 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9377 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9378
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009379 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009380 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009381
9382
9383stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9384 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 no | no | yes | yes
9387
9388 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9389 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9390 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9391 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9392
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009393 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9394 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009395 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009396
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009397 Examples :
9398 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009399 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009400
9401 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9402 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9403 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9404
9405
9406 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9407 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9408 backend http
9409 mode http
9410 balance roundrobin
9411 stick on src table https
9412 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9413 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9414 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9415
9416 backend https
9417 mode tcp
9418 balance roundrobin
9419 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9420 stick on src
9421 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9422 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9423
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009424 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009425
9426
9427stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9428 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 no | no | yes | yes
9431
9432 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009433 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009434 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009435 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009436 server is selected.
9437
9438 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9439 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9440 the "stick-table" statement.
9441
9442 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9443 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9444 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9445 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9446 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9447 address.
9448
9449 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9450 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9451 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9452 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9453 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9454 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9455 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9456 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9457 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9458 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9459
9460 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9461 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9462 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9463 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9464 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9465 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9466 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9467
9468 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9469 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9470 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9471 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9472
9473 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9474 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9475 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9476 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9477 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9478 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009479 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9480 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9481 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9482 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9483 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9484 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009485
9486 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9487 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9488 the request.
9489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009490 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9491 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009492 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009494 Example :
9495 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9496 # last 30 minutes
9497 backend pop
9498 mode tcp
9499 balance roundrobin
9500 stick store-request src
9501 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9502 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9503 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9504
9505 backend smtp
9506 mode tcp
9507 balance roundrobin
9508 stick match src table pop
9509 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9510 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009512 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009513 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009514
9515
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009516stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009517 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9518 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009519 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009521 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009522
9523 Arguments :
9524 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9525 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9526 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9527 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9528
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009529 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9530 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9531 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9532 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9533
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009534 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9535 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9536 instance.
9537
9538 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9539 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9540 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9541 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9542 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9543 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009544 to 32 characters.
9545
9546 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9547 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9548 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009549 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009550 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9551 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009552
9553 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009554 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9555 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009556 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9557 increase.
9558
9559 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009560 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9561 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9562 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009563
9564 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9565 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9566 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9567 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009568 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009569 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9570 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9571 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9572 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9573 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9574 parameter (see below).
9575
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009576 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9577 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9578 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9579 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9580 soft restart.
9581
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009582 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9583 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009584
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009585 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9586 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9587 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9588 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009589 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009590 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009591 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9592 if not expiration delay is specified.
9593
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009594 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9595 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9596 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9597 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009598 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9599 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9600 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9601 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9602 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9603 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9604 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9605 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9606 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9607 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9608 types and their arguments.
9609
9610 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9611 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9612 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9613 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9614
9615 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9616 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9617 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009618 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009619
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009620 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9621 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9622 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009624 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009626
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009627 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9628 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9629 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9630 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9631
9632 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9633 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9634 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9635 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9636 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9637 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9638
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009639 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9640 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9641 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9642 they were received.
9643
9644 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9645 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9646 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9647 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9648 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9649
9650 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9651 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9652 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9653 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9654 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9655
9656 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9657 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9658 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9659
9660 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9661 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9662 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9663 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9664 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9665
9666 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9667 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9668 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9669 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9670 the client side.
9671
9672 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9673 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9674 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9675 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9676 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9677 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9678 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9679
9680 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9681 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9682 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9683 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9684 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9685 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009686 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009687
9688 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9689 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9690 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9691 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9692 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9693 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9694
9695 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009697 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9698 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9699
9700 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9701 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9702 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9703 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9704 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9705 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9706 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9707 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9708 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9709 recommended for better fairness.
9710
9711 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009712 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009713 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9714 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9715
9716 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9717 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9718 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9719 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9720 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9721 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9722 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9723 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9724 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9725 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009726
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009727 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9728 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009729 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9730 reference it.
9731
9732 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9733 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009734 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9735 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9736 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009737
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009738 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9739 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9740 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9741 something that can be ignored.
9742
9743 Example:
9744 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9745 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9746 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9747 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9748
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009749 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009750 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009751
9752
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009753stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009754 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9756 no | no | yes | yes
9757
9758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009759 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009760 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009761 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009762 server is selected.
9763
9764 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9765 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9766 the "stick-table" statement.
9767
9768 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9769 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9770 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9771 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9772
9773 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9774 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9775 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9776 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9777 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9778 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009779 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009780 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9781 rules.
9782
9783 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9784 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9785 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9786 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9787 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9788 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9789 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9790
9791 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9792 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9793 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9794 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9795
9796 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9797 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9798 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9799 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9800 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9801 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009802 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9803 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9804 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9805 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9806 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9807 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9808 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9809 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9810 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009811
9812 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9813
9814 Example :
9815 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9816 backend https
9817 mode tcp
9818 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009819 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009820 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009821
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009822 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9823 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9824
9825 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9826 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9827 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9828
9829 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9830 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009831
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009832 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9833 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9834 # at offset 44.
9835
9836 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9837 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9838
9839 # Learn on response if server hello.
9840 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009841
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009842 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9843 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9844
9845 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9846 extraction.
9847
9848
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009849tcp-check connect [params*]
9850 Opens a new connection
9851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9852 no | no | yes | yes
9853
9854 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9855 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9856 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9857
9858 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9859 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9860 of the sequence.
9861
9862 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9863 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9864 do.
9865
9866 Parameters :
9867 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9868 use the TCP connection.
9869
9870 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9871 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9872 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9873
9874 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9875
9876 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9877
9878 Examples:
9879 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9880 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9881 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9882 option tcp-check
9883 tcp-check connect
9884 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9885 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9886 tcp-check send \r\n
9887 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9888 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9889 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9890 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9891 tcp-check send \r\n
9892 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9893 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9894
9895 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9896 option tcp-check
9897 tcp-check connect port 110
9898 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9899 tcp-check connect port 143
9900 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9901 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9902
9903 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9904
9905
9906tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009907 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 no | no | yes | yes
9910
9911 Arguments :
9912 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9913 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9914 binary.
9915 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9916 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9917 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9918
9919 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9920 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9921 with the usual backslash ('\').
9922 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009923 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009924 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9925 used upper or lower case.
9926
9927
9928 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9929
9930 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9931 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9932 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9933 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9934 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9935 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9936 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9937 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9938
9939 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9940 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9941 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9942 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9943 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9944 expression.
9945
9946 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9947 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9948 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9949 this exact hexadecimal string.
9950 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9951
9952 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9953 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9954 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9955 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9956 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9957 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9958 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9959 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9960 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9961 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9962 the null character.
9963
9964 Examples :
9965 # perform a POP check
9966 option tcp-check
9967 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9968
9969 # perform an IMAP check
9970 option tcp-check
9971 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9972
9973 # look for the redis master server
9974 option tcp-check
9975 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009976 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009977 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9978 tcp-check expect string role:master
9979 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9980 tcp-check expect string +OK
9981
9982
9983 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9984 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9985
9986
9987tcp-check send <data>
9988 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9990 no | no | yes | yes
9991
9992 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9993 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9994
9995 Examples :
9996 # look for the redis master server
9997 option tcp-check
9998 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9999 tcp-check expect string role:master
10000
10001 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10002 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10003
10004
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010005tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10006 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010007 tcp health check
10008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10009 no | no | yes | yes
10010
10011 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10012 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010013 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010014 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10015 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10016 hexadecimal string.
10017 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10018
10019 Examples :
10020 # redis check in binary
10021 option tcp-check
10022 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10023 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10024
10025
10026 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10027 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10028
10029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010030tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10031 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10033 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010034 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010035 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10036 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010037
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010038 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010039
10040 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10041 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010042 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10043 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10044 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10045 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10046 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10047 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010049 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10050 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10051 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10052 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010053
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010054 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010055 - accept :
10056 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10057 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10058 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010060 - reject :
10061 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10062 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10063 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10064 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10065 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10066 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10067 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10068 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10069 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10070 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10071 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010072 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010073
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010074 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10075 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10076 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10077 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10078 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10079 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10080 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10081 hosts.
10082
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010083 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10084 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10085 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10086 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10087 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10088 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10089 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10090 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10091
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010092 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10093 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10094 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10095 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10096 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10097 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10098 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10099 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10100 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010101 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10102 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010103
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010104 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010105 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010106 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10107 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10108 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010109 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010110 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10111 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10112 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10113 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10114 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10115 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10116 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10117 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010119 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010120 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010122 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010123 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10124 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10125 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010126
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010127 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10128 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10129 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10130 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010132 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10133 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10134 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10135 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10136 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010137 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10138 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10139 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10140 layer7 information is extracted.
10141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010142 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10143 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10144 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10145 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10146 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010147
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010148 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10149 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10150 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10151 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10152
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010153 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10154 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10155 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10156 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10157
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010158 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10159 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10160 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10161 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10162 continues.
10163
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010164 - set-src <expr> :
10165 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10166 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10167 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010168 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010170 Arguments:
10171 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10172 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010173
10174 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010175 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10176
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010177 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10178 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010179
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010180 - set-src-port <expr> :
10181 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10182 expression.
10183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010184 Arguments:
10185 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10186 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010187
10188 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010189 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10190
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010191 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10192 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10193 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010194
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010195 - set-dst <expr> :
10196 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10197 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10198 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10199 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10200 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10201
10202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10203 followed by some converters.
10204
10205 Example:
10206
10207 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10208 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10209
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010210 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10211 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10212
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010213 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10214 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10215 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10216 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10217
10218
10219 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10220 followed by some converters.
10221
10222 Example:
10223
10224 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10225
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010226 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10227 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10228 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10229
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010230 - "silent-drop" :
10231 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010232 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010233 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10234 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10235 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10236 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10237 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010238 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10239 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010240 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10241 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010242 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010243 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10244 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10245 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10246 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010248 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10249 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10250 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010252 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10253 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10254 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010256 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010257 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010258 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010260 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10261 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10262 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010264 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010265 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10266 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010267
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010268 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10269
10270 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10271
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010272 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10273
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010274 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010275
10276
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010277tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10278 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010280 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010281 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010282 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10283 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010285 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010287 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010288 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10289 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10290 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10291 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010293 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10294 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10295 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10296 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010297 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10298 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10299 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10300 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10301 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10302 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010303 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010304 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010306 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10307 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10308 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10309 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010310
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010311 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010312 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010313 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010314 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10315 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010316 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010317 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010318 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010319 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010320 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010321 - set-dst <expr>
10322 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010323 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010324 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010325 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010326 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010327 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010329 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10330 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010331 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10332 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010333
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010334 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10335 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10336 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10337 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10338 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10339 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010341 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010342 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10343 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010345 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010346 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10347 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10348 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10349 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010350 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10351 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10352 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010353
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010354 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010355 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10356 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10357 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010358
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010359 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10360 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10361
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010362 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010363 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10364 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010365
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010366 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10367 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010368 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010369 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10370 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010371 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010373 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010374 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10375 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010377 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10378 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010379
10380 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10381 followed by some converters.
10382
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010383 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10384 <var-name>.
10385
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010386 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10387 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10388 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10389 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10390 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10391
10392 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10393 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10394 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10395 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10396 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10397 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10398 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10399 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10400 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10401 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10402 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10403
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010404 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10405 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10406 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10407 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10408 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10409
10410 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10411
10412 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10413
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010414 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10415 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10416 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10417 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10418 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10419 evaluated.
10420
10421 Example:
10422 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10423
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010424 Example:
10425
10426 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010427 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010428
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010429 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010430 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10431 # and reject everything else.
10432 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10433 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010434 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010435 tcp-request content reject
10436
10437 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010438 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10439 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10440 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010441 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010442
10443 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10444 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10445 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010446 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010447 tcp-request content reject
10448
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010449 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010450 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010451 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010452 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010453 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10454 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010455
10456 Example:
10457 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10458 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010459 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010460
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010461 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010462 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463
10464 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010465 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010466 # protecting all our sites
10467 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010468 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10469 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010470 ...
10471 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10472
10473 backend http_dynamic
10474 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010475 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010476 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010477 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010478 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010479 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010480 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010482 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010483
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010484 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10485 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010486
10487
10488tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10489 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010491 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010492 Arguments :
10493 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10494 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10495 as explained at the top of this document.
10496
10497 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10498 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10499 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10500 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10501 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10502
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010503 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10504 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10505 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10506 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10507
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010508 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10509 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010510 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010511 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010512 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10513 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10514 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10515 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010516
10517 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10518 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10519 it pass through unaffected.
10520
10521 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10522 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10523 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010524 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010525 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10526 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010527 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10528 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10529 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010530
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010531 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010532 "timeout client".
10533
10534
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010535tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10536 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10538 no | no | yes | yes
10539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010540 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10541 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010542
10543 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10544
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010545 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010546 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10547 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010548 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10549 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010550
10551 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10552
10553 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10554 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10555 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10556 inserted.
10557
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010558 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010559 - accept :
10560 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10561 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10562 the rules evaluation.
10563
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010564 - close :
10565 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10566 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10567 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10568 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10569 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10570 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010571 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010572 protocols.
10573
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010574 - reject :
10575 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10576 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010577 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010578
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010579 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10580 Sets a variable.
10581
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010582 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10583 Unsets a variable.
10584
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010585 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10586 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10587 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10588 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10589
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010590 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10591 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10592 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10593 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10594
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010595 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10596 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10597 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10598 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10599 continues.
10600
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010601 - "silent-drop" :
10602 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010603 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010604 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10605 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10606 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10607 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10608 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010609 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10610 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010611 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10612 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010613 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010614 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10615 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10616 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10617 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10618
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010619 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10620 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10621
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010622 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10623 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10624 for changing the default action to a reject.
10625
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010626 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10627 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10628 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10629 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010630 period.
10631
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010632 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10633 declared inline.
10634
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010635 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10636 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010637 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010638 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10639 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010640 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010642 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10644 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010646 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10647 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010648
10649 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10650 followed by some converters.
10651
10652 Example:
10653
10654 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10655
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010656 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10657 <var-name>.
10658
10659 Example:
10660
10661 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10662
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010663 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10664 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10665 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10666 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10667 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10668
10669 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10670
10671 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10672
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010673 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10674
10675 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10676
10677
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010678tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10679 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10681 no | yes | yes | no
10682 Arguments :
10683 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10684 below.
10685
10686 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10687
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010688 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010689 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10690 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10691 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10692 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10693 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10694 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10695 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010696 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010697 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10698 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10699 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10700 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10701 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10702 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10703 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10704 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10705 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10706 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10707 instead.
10708
10709 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10710 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10711 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10712 rules which may be inserted.
10713
10714 Several types of actions are supported :
10715 - accept : the request is accepted
10716 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10717 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10718 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010719 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010720 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10721 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010722 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010723 - silent-drop
10724
10725 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10726 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10727 sections for a complete description.
10728
10729 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10730 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10731 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10732
10733 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10734 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10735 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10736 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10737 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10738
10739 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10740 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10741
10742 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10743 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10744 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10745
10746 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10747 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10748 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10749
10750 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10751 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10752 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10753
10754 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10755 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10756 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10757
10758 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10759
10760 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10761
10762
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010763tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10764 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10766 no | no | yes | yes
10767 Arguments :
10768 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10770 as explained at the top of this document.
10771
10772 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10773
10774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010775timeout check <timeout>
10776 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10777 established.
10778
10779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10780 yes | no | yes | yes
10781 Arguments:
10782 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10783 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10784 as explained at the top of this document.
10785
10786 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10787 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010788 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010789 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010790 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10791 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10792 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010793
10794 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10795 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10796
10797 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10798 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010799 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010800
10801 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10802 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10803 forget about it.
10804
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010805 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10806 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010807
10808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010809timeout client <timeout>
10810timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10811 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10813 yes | yes | yes | no
10814 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010815 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010816 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10817 as explained at the top of this document.
10818
10819 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10820 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10821 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010822 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10823 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10824 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10825 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010826 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10827 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10828 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010829 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010830 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010831 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10832 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010833 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10834 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010835
10836 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10837 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10838 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10839 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010840 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010841 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10842
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010843 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010845 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10846 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10847 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10848
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010849 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10850 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010851
10852
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010853timeout client-fin <timeout>
10854 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10856 yes | yes | yes | no
10857 Arguments :
10858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10860 as explained at the top of this document.
10861
10862 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10863 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10864 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10865 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10866 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10867 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10868 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010869 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10870 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10871 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010872
10873 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10874 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10875 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10876
10877 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10878
10879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010880timeout connect <timeout>
10881timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10882 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10884 yes | no | yes | yes
10885 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10888 as explained at the top of this document.
10889
10890 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010891 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010892 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010893 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010894 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10895 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010896
10897 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10898 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10899 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10900 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010901 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010902 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10903
10904 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10905 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10906 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10907
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010908 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10909 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010910
10911
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010912timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10913 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10915 yes | yes | yes | yes
10916 Arguments :
10917 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10918 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10919 as explained at the top of this document.
10920
10921 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10922 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10923 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10924 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10925 once the request has started to present itself.
10926
10927 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10928 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10929 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10930 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10931 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10932
10933 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10934 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10935 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10936 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10937
10938 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10939 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010940 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010941 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10942 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010943 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010944
10945 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10946 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10947 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10948 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10949
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010950 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10951 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010952 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10953
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010954 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10955
10956
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010957timeout http-request <timeout>
10958 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010960 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010962 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10964 as explained at the top of this document.
10965
10966 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10967 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10968 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10969 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10970 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10971 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10972 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010973 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10974 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10975 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10976 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010977 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010978 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10979 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010980
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010981 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10982 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10983 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10984 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10985 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010986 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010987
10988 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10989 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010991 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10992 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10993
10994 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010995 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10996 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10997 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010998
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010999 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011000 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011001
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011002
11003timeout queue <timeout>
11004 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11006 yes | no | yes | yes
11007 Arguments :
11008 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11009 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11010 as explained at the top of this document.
11011
11012 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11013 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11014 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11015 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11016 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11017
11018 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11019 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11020 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11021 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11022
11023 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11024
11025
11026timeout server <timeout>
11027timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11028 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11030 yes | no | yes | yes
11031 Arguments :
11032 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11033 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11034 as explained at the top of this document.
11035
11036 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11037 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11038 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11039 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11040 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11041 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11042 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11043
11044 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11045 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11046 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11047 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11048 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011049 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011050 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011051 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11052 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011053 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11054 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011055
11056 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11057 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11058 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11059 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011060 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011061 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11062
11063 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11064 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11065 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11066
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011067 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011068
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011069
11070timeout server-fin <timeout>
11071 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11073 yes | no | yes | yes
11074 Arguments :
11075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11077 as explained at the top of this document.
11078
11079 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11080 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11081 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11082 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11083 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11084 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11085 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11086 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11087 situations, it should not be needed.
11088
11089 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11090 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11091 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11092
11093 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11094
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011095
11096timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011097 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11099 yes | yes | yes | yes
11100 Arguments :
11101 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11102 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11103 as explained at the top of this document.
11104
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011105 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11106 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11107 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11108 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011109
11110 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11111 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11112 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11113 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011114 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011115
11116 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11117
11118
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011119timeout tunnel <timeout>
11120 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11122 yes | no | yes | yes
11123 Arguments :
11124 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11125 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11126 as explained at the top of this document.
11127
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011128 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011129 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11130 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11131 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011132 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11133 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011134 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11135 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11136 specified.
11137
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011138 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11139 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11140 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11141 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11142 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11143 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11144 state.
11145
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011146 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11147 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11148 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11149 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011150 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011151
11152 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11153 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11154 forget about it.
11155
11156 Example :
11157 defaults http
11158 option http-server-close
11159 timeout connect 5s
11160 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011161 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011162 timeout server 30s
11163 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11164
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011165 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011166
11167
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011168transparent (deprecated)
11169 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011171 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011172 Arguments : none
11173
11174 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11175 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11176 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11177 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11178 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11179 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11180 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11181 appropriate server.
11182
11183 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11184
11185 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11186 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11187
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011188 See also: "option transparent"
11189
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011190unique-id-format <string>
11191 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11193 yes | yes | yes | no
11194 Arguments :
11195 <string> is a log-format string.
11196
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011197 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11198 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11199 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11200 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011201
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011202 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11203 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11204 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11205 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11206 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11207 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11208 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11209 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011211 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11212 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011213
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011214 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011215
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011216 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011217
11218 will generate:
11219
11220 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11221
11222 See also: "unique-id-header"
11223
11224unique-id-header <name>
11225 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11227 yes | yes | yes | no
11228 Arguments :
11229 <name> is the name of the header.
11230
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011231 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11232 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011233
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011234 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011235
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011236 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011237 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11238
11239 will generate:
11240
11241 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11242
11243 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011244
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011245use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011246 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11248 no | yes | yes | no
11249 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011250 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11251 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011252
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011253 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11254 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011255
11256 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11257 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11258 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011259 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011260 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011261 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11262 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011263
11264 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11265 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11266 assign the backend.
11267
11268 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11269 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11270 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11271 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11272 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11273 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11274
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011275 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011276 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011277 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11278 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11279 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11280
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011281 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11282 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11283 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11284 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11285 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11286 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11287 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11288 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11289 cannot be forced from the request.
11290
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011291 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011292 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11293 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11294
11295 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11296 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011297
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011298
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011299use-server <server> if <condition>
11300use-server <server> unless <condition>
11301 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11303 no | no | yes | yes
11304 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011305 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011306
11307 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11308
11309 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11310 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11311 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11312
11313 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11314 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11315 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11316 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11317 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11318 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11319 matches will assign the server.
11320
11321 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11322 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11323 with the next rules until one matches.
11324
11325 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11326 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11327 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11328 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11329
11330 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11331 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11332 stripped.
11333
11334 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11335 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11336 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11337 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11338
11339 Example :
11340 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11341 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11342 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11343 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11344 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11345 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011346 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011347 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11348 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11349
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011350 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011351
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113535. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011354--------------------------
11355
11356The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11357depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11358settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11359written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11360described in this section.
11361
11362
113635.1. Bind options
11364-----------------
11365
11366The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11367as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11368no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11369parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11370while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11371provided immediately after the setting name.
11372
11373The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11374
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011375accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11376 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11377 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11378 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11379 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11380 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11381 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11382 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11383 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11384 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011385 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11386 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11387 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011388
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011389accept-proxy
11390 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011391 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11392 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011393 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11394 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11395 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11396 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011397 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011398 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11399 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011400 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11401 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011402
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011403allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011404 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011405 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011406 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011407 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11408 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011409
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011410alpn <protocols>
11411 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11412 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11413 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011414 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011415 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011416 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11417 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11418 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11419 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11420 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11421 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11422 preference, like below :
11423
11424 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011425
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011426backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011427 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011428 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11429
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011430curves <curves>
11431 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11432 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11433 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11434 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11435 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11436 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11437
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011438ecdhe <named curve>
11439 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011440 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11441 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011442
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011443ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11445 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11446 client's certificate.
11447
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011448ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11449 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11450 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11451 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11452 error is ignored.
11453
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011454ca-sign-file <cafile>
11455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11456 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11457 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11458 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11459 'generate-certificates' for details.
11460
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011461ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11463 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11464 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11465 'generate-certificates' for details.
11466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011467ciphers <ciphers>
11468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11469 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011470 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011471 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011472 information and recommendations see e.g.
11473 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11474 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11475 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11476
11477ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11479 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11480 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11481 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011482 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11483 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011484
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011485crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11487 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11488 to verify client's certificate.
11489
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011490crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11492 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11493 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11494 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11495 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11496 file.
11497
11498 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11499 are loaded.
11500
11501 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011502 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011503 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11504 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11505 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11506 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011507 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11508 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011509 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011510
11511 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11512 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11513 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11514 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011515 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11516 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011517
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011518 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011519
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011520 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011521 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011522 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11523 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011524 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11525 clients).
11526
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011527 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11528 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11529 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11530 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11531 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11532 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11533 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11534 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11535 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11536 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11537 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11538 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11539 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11540
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011541 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11542 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11543 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11544 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11545 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11546
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011547 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11548 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11549 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11550 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011551
11552 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11553 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11554 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11555 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11556 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11557 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11558 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11559 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11560 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11561
11562 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11563
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011564 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011565 a cert bundle.
11566
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011567 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011568 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11569 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11570 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11571 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11572 provide multi-cert support.
11573
11574 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11575
11576 Filename | CN | SAN
11577 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11578 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011579 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011580 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11581 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11582
11583 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11584 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11585 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11586 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011587 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11588 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11589 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011590
11591 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11592 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11593
11594 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11595 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11596 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11597
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011598crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011599 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011600 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011601 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011602 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011603
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011604crt-list <file>
11605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011606 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11607 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011608
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011609 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11610
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011611 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11612 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011613 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011614 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011615
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011616 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11617 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11618 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11619 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11620 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11621 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11622 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11623 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011624
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011625 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011626 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011627 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11628 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11629 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011630
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011631 crt-list file example:
11632 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011633 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011634 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011635 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011636
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011637defer-accept
11638 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11639 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11640 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011641 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011642 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11643 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11644 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11645 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11646 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11647 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11648 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11649
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011650expose-fd listeners
11651 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11652 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011653 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11654 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011655 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011656
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011657force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011658 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011659 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011660 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011661 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011662
11663force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011664 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011665 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011666 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011667
11668force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011669 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011670 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011671 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011672
11673force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011674 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011675 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011676 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011677
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011678force-tlsv13
11679 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11680 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011681 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011682
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011683generate-certificates
11684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11685 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11686 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11687 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11688 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11689 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11690 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11691 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11692 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11693 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11694 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11695
11696 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11697 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011698 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011699 certificate is used many times.
11700
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011701gid <gid>
11702 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11703 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11704 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11705 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11706 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11707
11708group <group>
11709 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11710 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11711 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11712 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11713 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11714
11715id <id>
11716 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11717 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11718 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11719 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11720
11721interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011722 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11723 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11724 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11725 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11726 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11727 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011728 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11729 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11730 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11731 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11732 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11733 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011734
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011735level <level>
11736 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11737 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11738 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011739 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011740 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11741 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11742 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011743 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011744 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011745 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011746 all counters).
11747
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011748severity-output <format>
11749 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11750 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11751 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11752 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11753 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11754 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11755 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11756 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11757 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11758 rfc5424 convention.
11759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011760maxconn <maxconn>
11761 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11762 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11763 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11764 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11765 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11766 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11767 eat all memory.
11768
11769mode <mode>
11770 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11771 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11772 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11773 UNIX sockets.
11774
11775mss <maxseg>
11776 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11777 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11778 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11779 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11780 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11781 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11782 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11783 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11784 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11785 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11786 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11787
11788name <name>
11789 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11790 page.
11791
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011792namespace <name>
11793 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11794 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11795 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11796 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11797
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011798nice <nice>
11799 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11800 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11801 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11802 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11803 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11804 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11805 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11806 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11807 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11808 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11809 one for an RDP socket.
11810
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011811no-ca-names
11812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11813 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11814
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011815no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011817 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011818 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011819 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011820 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11821 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011822
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011823no-tls-tickets
11824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11825 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11826 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011827 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11828 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011829 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11830 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11831 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011832
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011833no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011835 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011836 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011837 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011838 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11839 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011841no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011843 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011844 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011845 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011846 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11847 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011848
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011849no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011851 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011852 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011853 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011854 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11855 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011856
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011857no-tlsv13
11858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11859 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11860 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11861 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011862 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11863 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011864
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011865npn <protocols>
11866 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11867 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11868 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011869 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011870 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011871 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11872 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11873 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11874 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11875 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011876
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011877prefer-client-ciphers
11878 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11879 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11880 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011881 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11882 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11883 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011884
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011885process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011886 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011887 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011888 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011889 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11890 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11891 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11892 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011893 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011894 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11895 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11896 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11897 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11898 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011899
11900 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11901
11902 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11903 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11904 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11905 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11906 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11907 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11908 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11909 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011910
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011911proto <name>
11912 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11913 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11914 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11915 in haproxy -vv.
11916 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11917 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011918 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011919 h2" on the bind line.
11920
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011921ssl
11922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011923 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011924 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11925 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011926 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11927 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011928
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011929ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11930 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11931 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11933
11934ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11935 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11936 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11937 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11938
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011939strict-sni
11940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11941 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11942 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11943 See the "crt" option for more information.
11944
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011945tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011946 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011947 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11948 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011949 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011950 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11951 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11952 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11953 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11954 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11955 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11956 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11957
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011958tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011960 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11961 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11962 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11963 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11964 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11965 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11966 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011967 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11968 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11969 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011970
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011971tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11972 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011973 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11974 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11975 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11976 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11977 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11978 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11979 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11980 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11981 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11982 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011983 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11984 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11985
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011986transparent
11987 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11988 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11989 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11990 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11991 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11992 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11993 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11994 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11995 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11996 so check for support with your vendor.
11997
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011998v4v6
11999 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12000 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12001 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12002 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012003 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012004
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012005v6only
12006 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12007 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12008 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012009 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12010 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012011
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012012uid <uid>
12013 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12014 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12015 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12016 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12017 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12018
12019user <user>
12020 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12021 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12022 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12023 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12024 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12025
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012026verify [none|optional|required]
12027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12028 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12029 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12030 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12031 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012032 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12033 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12034 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12035 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120375.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012038------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012040The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12041which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12042arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12043settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12044after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12045Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12046address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012048 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012049 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012050
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012051Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12052keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012054The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012055
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012056addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012057 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012058 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12059 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12060 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12061 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12062 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012063
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012064agent-check
12065 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012066 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012067 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12068 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12069 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012070
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012071 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012072 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012073 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12074 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12075 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012076
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012077 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12078 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12079 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12080 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12081 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012082
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012083 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012084 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012085
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012086 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12087 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12088 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012089
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012090 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12091 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12092 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012093
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012094 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12095 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12096 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12097 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12098 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012099 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012100 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012101
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012102 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12103 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012104
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012105 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12106 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12107 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12108 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12109 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12110 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12111 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12112 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12113 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012114
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012115 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12116 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012117 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12118 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12119 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012120 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012121
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012122 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012123 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012124
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012125agent-send <string>
12126 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12127 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12128 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12129 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12130 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12131
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012132agent-inter <delay>
12133 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12134 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12135
12136 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12137 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12138 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12139 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12140 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12141 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12142 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12143 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12144 of backends use the same servers.
12145
12146 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12147
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012148agent-addr <addr>
12149 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12150
12151 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12152 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12153 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12154 hostname, it will be resolved.
12155
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012156agent-port <port>
12157 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12158
12159 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12160
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012161allow-0rtt
12162 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012163 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12164 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012165
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012166alpn <protocols>
12167 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12168 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12169 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012170 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012171 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12172 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12173 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12174 now obsolete NPN extension.
12175 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12176 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12177
12178 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012180backup
12181 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12182 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12183 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12184 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012185 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12186 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012187
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012188ca-file <cafile>
12189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12190 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12191 server's certificate.
12192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012193check
12194 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012195 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12196 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12197 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12198 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12199 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12200 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12201 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012202 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12203 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012204 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12205 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012206
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012207check-send-proxy
12208 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12209 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12210 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12211 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12212 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12213 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12214 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12215
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012216check-alpn <protocols>
12217 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12218 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12219 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12220
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012221check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012222 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012223 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12224 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012225
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012226check-ssl
12227 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12228 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12229 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12230 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012231 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012232 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12233 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012235 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12236 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012237
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012238check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012239 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012240 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12241 for normal traffic.
12242
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012243ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12245 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12246 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012247 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12248 information and recommendations see e.g.
12249 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12250 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12251 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012252
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012253ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12255 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12256 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12257 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012258 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12259 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12260 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012262cookie <value>
12263 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12264 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12265 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12266 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12267 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12268 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12269 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12270
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012271crl-file <crlfile>
12272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12273 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12274 to verify server's certificate.
12275
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012276crt <cert>
12277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12278 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12279 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12280 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12281 certificate request.
12282
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012283disabled
12284 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12285 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12286 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12287 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12288 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012289 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012290
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012291enabled
12292 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12293 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12294 default value.
12295 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12296 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012298error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012299 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12300 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12301 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012303 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012305fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012306 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12307 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12308 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12309
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012310force-sslv3
12311 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12312 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012313 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012314 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012315
12316force-tlsv10
12317 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012318 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012319 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012320
12321force-tlsv11
12322 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012323 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012324 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012325
12326force-tlsv12
12327 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012328 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012329 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012330
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012331force-tlsv13
12332 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12333 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012334 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012336id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012337 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12338 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12339 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012340
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012341init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12342 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12343 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012344 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012345 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12346 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12347 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12348 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12349 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12350 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12351 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12352 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12353 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012354 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012355 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12356 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12357 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12358 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12359 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12360 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012361 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012362
12363 Example:
12364 defaults
12365 # never fail on address resolution
12366 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012368inter <delay>
12369fastinter <delay>
12370downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012371 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12372 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12373 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12374 between checks depending on the server state :
12375
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012376 Server state | Interval used
12377 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12378 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12379 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12380 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12381 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12382 or yet unchecked. |
12383 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12384 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12385 | "inter" otherwise.
12386 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012388 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12389 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12390 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12391 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012392 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12393 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12394 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12395 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12396 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012398maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012399 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12400 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012401 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12402 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012403 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12404 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12405 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12406 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12407
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012408 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12409 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12410 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12411 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12412 than 50 concurrent requests.
12413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012414maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012415 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12416 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12417 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12418 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12419 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12420 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12421 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12422
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012423max-reuse <count>
12424 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12425 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12426 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12427 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12428 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12429 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12430 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12431 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012433minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012434 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12435 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12436 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12437 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12438 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12439 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012440 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012441 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012442
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012443namespace <name>
12444 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12445 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12446 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12447 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12448
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012449no-agent-check
12450 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12451 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12452 default value.
12453 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12454 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12455
12456no-backup
12457 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12458 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12459 default value.
12460 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12461 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12462
12463no-check
12464 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12465 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12466 default value.
12467 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12468 "default-server" "check" setting.
12469
12470no-check-ssl
12471 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12472 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12473 default value.
12474 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12475 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12476
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012477no-send-proxy
12478 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12479 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12480 default value.
12481 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12482 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12483
12484no-send-proxy-v2
12485 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12486 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12487 default value.
12488 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12489 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12490
12491no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12492 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12493 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12494 default value.
12495 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12496 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12497
12498no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12499 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12500 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12501 default value.
12502 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12503 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12504
12505no-ssl
12506 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12507 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12508 default value.
12509 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12510 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12511
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012512no-ssl-reuse
12513 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12514 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12515 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12516 and for paranoid users.
12517
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012518no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012519 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12520 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012521 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012522
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012523 Supported in default-server: No
12524
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012525no-tls-tickets
12526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12527 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12528 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012529 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12530 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012531 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12532 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12533 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012534 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012535
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012536no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012537 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012538 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12539 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012540 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12541 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012542 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012543
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012544 Supported in default-server: No
12545
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012546no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012547 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012548 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12549 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012550 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12551 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012552 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012553
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012554 Supported in default-server: No
12555
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012556no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012557 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012558 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12559 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012560 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12561 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012562 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012563
12564 Supported in default-server: No
12565
12566no-tlsv13
12567 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12568 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12569 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12570 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12571 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012572 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012573
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012574 Supported in default-server: No
12575
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012576no-verifyhost
12577 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12578 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12579 default value.
12580 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12581 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012582
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012583no-tfo
12584 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12585 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12586 default value.
12587 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12588 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12589
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012590non-stick
12591 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12592 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12593 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12594
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012595npn <protocols>
12596 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12597 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12598 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012599 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012600 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12601 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12602 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012604observe <mode>
12605 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12606 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12607 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12608 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12609 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12610 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012611 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012612
12613 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012615on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012616 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12617 Currently, four modes are available:
12618 - fastinter: force fastinter
12619 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12620 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12621 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12622 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12623
12624 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12625
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012626on-marked-down <action>
12627 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12628 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012629 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12630 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12631 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12632 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12633 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12634 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12635 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12636 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012637
12638 Actions are disabled by default
12639
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012640on-marked-up <action>
12641 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12642 Currently one action is available:
12643 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12644 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12645 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12646 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12648 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012649 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12650 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12651
12652 Actions are disabled by default
12653
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012654pool-max-conn <max>
12655 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12656 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12657 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12658 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12659 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12660 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12661
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012662pool-purge-delay <delay>
12663 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012664 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012665 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012667port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012668 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12669 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12670 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12671 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12672 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12673 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12674
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012675proto <name>
12676
12677 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12678 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12679 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12680 reported in haproxy -vv.
12681 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12682 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012684redir <prefix>
12685 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12686 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12687 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12688 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12689 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12690 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12691 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12692 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012693 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012694 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012695 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12696 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12697 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12698 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12699
12700 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012702rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012703 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12704 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12705 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12706
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012707resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12708 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12709 server.
12710
12711 Available options:
12712
12713 * allow-dup-ip
12714 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12715 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12716 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12717 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12718 For such case, simply enable this option.
12719 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12720
12721 * prevent-dup-ip
12722 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12723 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12724 same fqdn.
12725 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12726
12727 Example:
12728 backend b_myapp
12729 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12730 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12731 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12732
12733 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12734 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12735 it
12736 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12737 different address
12738
12739 Default value: not set
12740
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012741resolve-prefer <family>
12742 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12743 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12744 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12745 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12746
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012747 Default value: ipv6
12748
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012749 Example:
12750
12751 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012752
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012753resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012754 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012755 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012756 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012757 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12758 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012759 configured network, another address is selected.
12760
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012761 Example:
12762
12763 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012764
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012765resolvers <id>
12766 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12767 hostname.
12768
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012769 Example:
12770
12771 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012772
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012773 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012774
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012775send-proxy
12776 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12777 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12778 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12779 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012780 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12781 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12782 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12783 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12784 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12785 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12786 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12787 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12788 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12789 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012790 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12791 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012792
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012793send-proxy-v2
12794 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12795 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12796 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12797 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012798 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12799 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12800 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12801 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012802
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012803proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12804 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12805 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012806 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12807 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012808 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12809 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012810 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012811
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012812send-proxy-v2-ssl
12813 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12814 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12815 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12816 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12817 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12818 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12819 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012820 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12821 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012822
12823send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12824 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12825 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12826 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12827 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12828 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12829 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12830 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12831 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012832 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12833 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012835slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012836 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12837 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12838 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12839 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12840 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12841 parameters :
12842
12843 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12844 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12845
12846 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12847 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12848 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12849 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12850
12851 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12852 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12853 seen as failed.
12854
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012855sni <expression>
12856 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12857 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12858 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12859 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012860 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12861 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012862 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012863 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12864 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012865
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012866source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012867source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012868source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012869 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12870 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12871 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12872 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12873
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012874 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12875 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12876 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12877 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12878 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12879 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12880 server.
12881
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012882 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12883 specifying the source address without port(s).
12884
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012885ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012886 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12887 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12888 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12889 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12890 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12891 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012892 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12893 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012894
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012895ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12896 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12897 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12898 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12899
12900ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12901 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12902 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12903 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12904
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012905ssl-reuse
12906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12908 default value.
12909 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12910 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12911
12912stick
12913 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12914 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12915 default value.
12916 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12917 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012918
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012919socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012920 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012921 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12922 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12923
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012924tcp-ut <delay>
12925 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12926 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12927 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012928 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012929 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12930 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12931 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12932 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12933 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12934 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12935 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12936 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12937 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12938
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012939tfo
12940 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12941 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12942 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12943 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12944 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012945 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012947track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012948 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12949 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12950 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12951 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012952 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12953
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012954tls-tickets
12955 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12956 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12957 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012958 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12959 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12960 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012961 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012962 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012963
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012964verify [none|required]
12965 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012966 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012967 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12968 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012969 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012970 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12971 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12972 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12973 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12974 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12975 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12976 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12977 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012978
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012979verifyhost <hostname>
12980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012981 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12982 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12983 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12984 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12985 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12986 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12987 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12988 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012990weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012991 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12992 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12993 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012994 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12995 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12996 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12997 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12998 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12999 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013000
13001
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130025.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13003-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013004
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013005HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13006using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13007configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013008This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13009can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13010workload.
13011This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13012resolution at run time.
13013Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13014carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13015
13016
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130175.3.1. Global overview
13018----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013019
13020As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13021different steps of the process life:
13022
13023 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13024 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13025 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13026
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013027 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13028 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013029
13030A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13031 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13032 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13033 resolution to know this new IP.
13034
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013035When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013036HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013037SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13038from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13039will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13040will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013041
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013042A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013043 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013044 first valid response.
13045
13046 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13047 servers return an error.
13048
13049
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130505.3.2. The resolvers section
13051----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013052
13053This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013054HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13055contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013056
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013057When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13058uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13059is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13060answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13061
13062When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013063used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013064
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013065 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13066 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13067 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013068
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013069 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13070 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013071
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013072 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13073 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13074 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013075
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013076For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13077following scenarios are possible:
13078
13079 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13080 ignored
13081
13082 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13083 applied
13084
13085 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13086 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13087
13088 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13089 retries the query with a new type
13090
13091 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13092 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013093
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013094As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13095a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013096<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013097
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013098
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013099resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013100 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013101
13102A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13103
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013104accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013105 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013106 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013107 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13108 by RFC 6891)
13109
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013110 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13111
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013112nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13113 DNS server description:
13114 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13115 <ip> : IP address of the server
13116 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13117
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013118parse-resolv-conf
13119 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13120 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13121 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13122
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013123hold <status> <period>
13124 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13125 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013126 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013127 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013128 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13129 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13130 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13131
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013132 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013133
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013134resolve_retries <nb>
13135 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13136 giving up.
13137 Default value: 3
13138
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013139 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13140 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13141 type.
13142
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013143timeout <event> <time>
13144 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13145 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13146 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013147 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13148 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013149 Default value: 1s
13150 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013151 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013152 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013153 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13154 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13155
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013156 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013157
13158 resolvers mydns
13159 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13160 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013161 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013162 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013163 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013164 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013165 hold other 30s
13166 hold refused 30s
13167 hold nx 30s
13168 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013169 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013170 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013171
13172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131736. HTTP header manipulation
13174---------------------------
13175
13176In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13177response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13178request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13179which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013180against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013181
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013182If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13183to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13184but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13185HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13186stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13187because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13188a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13189still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013191This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13192in section 4.2 :
13193
13194 - reqadd <string>
13195 - reqallow <search>
13196 - reqiallow <search>
13197 - reqdel <search>
13198 - reqidel <search>
13199 - reqdeny <search>
13200 - reqideny <search>
13201 - reqpass <search>
13202 - reqipass <search>
13203 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13204 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13205 - reqtarpit <search>
13206 - reqitarpit <search>
13207 - rspadd <string>
13208 - rspdel <search>
13209 - rspidel <search>
13210 - rspdeny <search>
13211 - rspideny <search>
13212 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13213 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13214
13215With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13216is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13217parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13218prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13219Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13220
13221 \t for a tab
13222 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13223 \n for a new line (LF)
13224 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13225 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13226 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13227 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13228 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13229
13230The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13231portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13232above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13233regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132349 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13235is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13236
13237The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13238after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13239
13240Notes related to these keywords :
13241---------------------------------
13242 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13243 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13244 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13245
13246 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13247 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13248 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13249
13250 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13251 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13252 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13253 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13254 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13255
13256 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13257 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13258 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13259 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13260 useless headers before adding new ones.
13261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013262 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013263 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13264
13265 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13266 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13267 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13268
13269 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13270 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013271 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013272
13273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13275----------------------------------
13276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013277HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13279The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13280these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13281but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13282data called patterns.
13283
13284
132857.1. ACL basics
13286---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013287
13288The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13289content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13290from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13291simple :
13292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013294 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013295 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13296 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13299adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013300
13301In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013303 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013304
13305This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13306Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13307and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013308an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13309conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13310as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13311are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013312
13313ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13314'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13315which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13316
13317There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13318performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013320The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13321specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13322this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013323methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13324ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013325
13326Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13327 - boolean
13328 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13329 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13330 - string
13331 - data block
13332
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013333Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13334converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13335would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13336The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13337which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13338
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013339Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13340keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13341fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13342which are summarized in the table below :
13343
13344 +---------------------+-----------------+
13345 | Sample or converter | Default |
13346 | output type | matching method |
13347 +---------------------+-----------------+
13348 | boolean | bool |
13349 +---------------------+-----------------+
13350 | integer | int |
13351 +---------------------+-----------------+
13352 | ip | ip |
13353 +---------------------+-----------------+
13354 | string | str |
13355 +---------------------+-----------------+
13356 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13357 +---------------------+-----------------+
13358
13359Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13360matching method, see below.
13361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13363 - boolean
13364 - integer or integer range
13365 - IP address / network
13366 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13367 - regular expression
13368 - hex block
13369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013370The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13371
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013372 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13373 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013374 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013375 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013376 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013377 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013378 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13381read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13382if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13383lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13384will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13385beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13386a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13387lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13388exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13389
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013390The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13391parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13392ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13393a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13394check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13395
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013396The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13397socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13398file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13401loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13402
13403 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13404
13405In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13406the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13407case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13408as well.
13409
13410The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13411sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13412do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13413methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13414is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013415obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013416followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13417default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13418that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13419string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13420
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013421The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13422By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13423string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13424resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13425server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013426waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013427flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13428function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13431sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13432be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013433
13434 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13435 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013436 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13437 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13438 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13439 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013440
13441 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13442 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013444
13445 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013447
13448 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013450
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013451 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013452 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13453
13454 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13455 binary or string samples.
13456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013457 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13458 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13461 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13462 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13465 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13468 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13471 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13474 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013475 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013477 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13478 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13479 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013480
13481For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13482request, it is possible to do :
13483
13484 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13485
13486In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13487buffer, one would use the following acl :
13488
13489 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13490
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013491On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13492possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13493
13494 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013496All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13497criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13498method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13499to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13500criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13501the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013503If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013504the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13505For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13508 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13509 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13510 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013511
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013512
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013513The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13514types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13515combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13516brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13517default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013519 +-------------------------------------------------+
13520 | Input sample type |
13521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013522 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13524 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013526 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013528 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013530 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013532 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013534 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013536 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013538 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013539 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013540 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013542 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013544 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013546 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13548 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13549 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013550
13551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135527.1.1. Matching booleans
13553------------------------
13554
13555In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13556Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13557When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13558that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13559
13560Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13561return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13562"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135657.1.2. Matching integers
13566------------------------
13567
13568Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13569enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13570to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13571
13572Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13573matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13574lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013575
13576For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13577unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13578representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13579
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013580As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13581two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13582instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13583ranges and operators.
13584
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013585For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013586operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13587Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13588of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013590Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013591
13592 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13593 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13594 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13595 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13596 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013598For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013599
13600 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13601
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013602This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13603
13604 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136077.1.3. Matching strings
13608-----------------------
13609
13610String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13611different forms :
13612
13613 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013614 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013615
13616 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013618
13619 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13620 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13621
13622 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13623 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13624
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013625 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013626 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13627 matches.
13628
13629 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13630 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13631 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013632
13633String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13634exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13635characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13636string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13637to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013638before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013639
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013640Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13641(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13642Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13643
13644Example:
13645 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13646 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136497.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13650---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013651
13652Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13653they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13654possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13655passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13656the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013657the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13658match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013659
13660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136617.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13662-------------------------------------
13663
13664It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13665not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13666a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13667to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13668digits may be used upper or lower case.
13669
13670Example :
13671 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13672 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13673
13674
136757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13676---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013677
13678IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13679netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13680within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013681host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013682difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13683at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13684does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13685parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013686
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013687The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13688abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13689
13690 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13691 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13692 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13693 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13694 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13695 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13696 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13697 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13698
13699Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13700192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13701
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013702IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13703Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13704trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13705IPv6 patterns.
13706
13707HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13708following situations :
13709 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13710 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13711 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13712 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13713 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13714 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13715 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13716 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13717 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13718 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013720
137217.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13722----------------------------------
13723
13724Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13725combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13726
13727 - AND (implicit)
13728 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13729 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13736indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13739"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13740requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13741is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13742
13743 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013744 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13745 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13746 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747
13748To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13749and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13750
13751 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13752 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13753 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13754 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013756 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013757 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13758 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13759 use_backend www if host_www
13760
13761It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13762expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13763be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13764the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13765
13766 The following rule :
13767
13768 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013769 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013770
13771 Can also be written that way :
13772
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013773 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774
13775It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13776to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13777simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13778sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13779good use is the following :
13780
13781 With named ACLs :
13782
13783 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13784 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13785 monitor fail if site_dead
13786
13787 With anonymous ACLs :
13788
13789 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13790
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013791See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13792keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013793
13794
137957.3. Fetching samples
13796---------------------
13797
13798Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13799against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13800sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13801ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13802of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13803available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13804
13805This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13806Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13807compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13808deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13809
13810The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13811matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13812method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13813indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13814
13815As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13816when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13817mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13818the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13819ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13820
13821Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13822multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13823when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013824incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13825are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13827all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13828
13829Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13830 - name
13831 - name(arg1)
13832 - name(arg1,arg2)
13833
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013834
138357.3.1. Converters
13836-----------------
13837
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013838Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13839of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13840is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13841was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013842has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013843unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13844
13845These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13846sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13847the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013848support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013849
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013850A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13851support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13852supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13853(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13854bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013856The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013857
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001385851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13859 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13860 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13861 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13862 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13863 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13864
13865 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013866 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13867 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013868 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13869 frontend http-in
13870 bind *:8081
13871 default_backend servers
13872 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13873 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13874
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013875add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013876 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013877 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013878 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13879 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013880 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013881 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13882 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13883 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13884 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013885 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013886 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013887
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013888aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13889 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13890 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13891 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13892 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13893 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13894 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13895
13896 Example:
13897 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13898 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13899
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013900and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013901 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013902 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013903 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13904 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013905 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013906 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13907 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13908 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13909 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013910 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013911 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013912
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013913b64dec
13914 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13915 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13916
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013917base64
13918 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013919 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013920 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13921
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013922bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013923 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013924 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013925 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013926 presence of a flag).
13927
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013928bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13929 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13930 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013931 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013932
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013933concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13934 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13935 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13936 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13937 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13938 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13939 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13940 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13941 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13942 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13943 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013944 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013945 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013946 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013947
13948 Example:
13949 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13950 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13951 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13952 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13953
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013954cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013955 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13956 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013957
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013958crc32([<avalanche>])
13959 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13960 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13961 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13962 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13963 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13964 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13965 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13966 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13967 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13968 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013969 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13970
13971crc32c([<avalanche>])
13972 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13973 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13974 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13975 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13976 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13977 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13978 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13979 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013980
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013981da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013982 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13983 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13984 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13985 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013986 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013987 configuration language.
13988
13989 Example:
13990 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013991 bind *:8881
13992 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013993 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013994
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013995debug
13996 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13997 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13998 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13999
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014000div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014001 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14002 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014003 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014004 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14005 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14009 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14010 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014011 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014012 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014013
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014014djb2([<avalanche>])
14015 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14016 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14017 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14018 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14019 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14020 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14021 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014022 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14023 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014024
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014025even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014026 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014027 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14028
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014029field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14030 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14031 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14032 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14033 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14034 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14035 fields.
14036
14037 Example :
14038 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14039 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14040 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14041 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14042 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014043
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014044hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014046 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014047 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014048 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014049
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014050hex2i
14051 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014052 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014054http_date([<offset>])
14055 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14056 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14057 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14058 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14059 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14060 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014062in_table(<table>)
14063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14065 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014066 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014067 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14068
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014069ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14070 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014071 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014072 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14073 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14074 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14075 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14076 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014077
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014078json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014079 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014080 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014081 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014082 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14083 of errors:
14084 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14085 bytes, ...)
14086 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14087 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14088
14089 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14090 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14091 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14092 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14093 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14094 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014095 - "ascii" : never fails;
14096 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14097 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014098 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014099 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014100 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14101 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14102
14103 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014105
14106 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014107 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014108 capture request header user-agent len 150
14109 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014110
14111 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14112 GET / HTTP/1.0
14113 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14114
14115 Output log:
14116 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14117
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014118language(<value>[,<default>])
14119 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14120 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14121 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14122 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14123 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14124 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14125 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14126 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14127 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014128 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014129 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14130 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014132 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014133
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014134 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14135 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014136
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014137 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14138 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14139 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14140 use_backend spanish if es
14141 use_backend french if fr
14142 use_backend english if en
14143 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014144
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014145length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014146 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14147 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14148 type. The result is of type integer.
14149
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014150lower
14151 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14152 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14153 type. The result is of type string.
14154
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014155ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14156 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14157 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14158 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14159 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14160 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14161 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14162
14163 Example :
14164
14165 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014166 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014167 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14168
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014169map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14170map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14171map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14172 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14173 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14174 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14175 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14176 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14177 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14178 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14179 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014180
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014181 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14182 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14183 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014184
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014185 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014186 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014187
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014188 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14189 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14190 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14191 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014192 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014194 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14195 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14196 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14197 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14198 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14199 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14200 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14201 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014202 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14203 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14204 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014205 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14206 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14207 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14208 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14209 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014210
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014211 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14212 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14213 the corresponding match text.
14214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014215 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14216 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14217 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14218 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14219 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014220
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014221 Example :
14222
14223 # this is a comment and is ignored
14224 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14225 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14226 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14227 | | | `---------- value
14228 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14229 | `---------------------------- key
14230 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14231
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014232mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014233 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14234 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014235 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014236 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014237 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014238 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14239 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14240 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14241 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014243 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014244
14245mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014246 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014247 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14248 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014249 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014250 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014251 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014252 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14253 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14254 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14255 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014256 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014257 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014258
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014259nbsrv
14260 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14261 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14262 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14263 map lookup.
14264
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014265neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014266 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14267 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14268 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14269 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014270
14271not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014272 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014273 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014274 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014275 absence of a flag).
14276
14277odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014278 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014279 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14280
14281or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014282 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014283 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014284 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14285 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014286 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14289 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14290 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014291 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014292 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014293
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014294protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14295 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14296 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14297 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14298 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14299 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14300 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14301 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14302 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14303 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14304 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14305 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14306
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014307regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014308 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14309 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14310 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14311 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14312 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14313 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14314 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14315 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14316 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14317 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014318 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14319 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14320 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14321 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014322
14323 Example :
14324
14325 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14326 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14327 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14328 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14329
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014330capture-req(<id>)
14331 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14332 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14333
14334 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014335 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14336 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014337
14338capture-res(<id>)
14339 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14340 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14341
14342 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014343 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14344 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014345
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014346sdbm([<avalanche>])
14347 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14348 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14349 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14350 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14351 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14352 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14353 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014354 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14355 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014356
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014357set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014358 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14359 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14360 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014361 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014362 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14363 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014364 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014365 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14366 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014367 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014368 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014369
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014370sha1
14371 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14372 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14373
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014374strcmp(<var>)
14375 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14376 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14377 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14378 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14379 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14380 shorter).
14381
14382 Example :
14383
14384 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14385 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14386 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14387
14388
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014389sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014390 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14391 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014392 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014393 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14394 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014395 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014396 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14397 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014398 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014399 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14400 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014401 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014402 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014403
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014404table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14405 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14406 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14407 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14408 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14409 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14410 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14411
14412
14413table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14414 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14415 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14416 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14417 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14418 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14419 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14420
14421table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14422 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14423 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014424 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014425 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14426 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14427
14428table_conn_cur(<table>)
14429 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14430 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14431 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14432 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14433 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14434
14435table_conn_rate(<table>)
14436 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14437 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14438 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14439 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14440 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14441
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014442table_gpt0(<table>)
14443 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14444 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14445 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14446 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14447 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14448
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014449table_gpc0(<table>)
14450 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14451 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14452 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14453 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14454 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14455
14456table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14460 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14461 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14462 sample fetch keyword.
14463
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014464table_gpc1(<table>)
14465 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14466 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14467 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14468 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14469 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14470
14471table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14472 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14473 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14474 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14475 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14476 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14477 sample fetch keyword.
14478
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014479table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14480 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14481 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014482 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014483 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14484 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14485
14486table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14487 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14488 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14489 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14490 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14491 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14492 keyword.
14493
14494table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14495 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14496 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014497 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014498 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14499 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14500
14501table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14502 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14503 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14504 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14505 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14506 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14507 keyword.
14508
14509table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14510 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14511 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014512 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014513 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14514 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14515 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14516 keyword.
14517
14518table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014521 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014522 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14523 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14524 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14525 keyword.
14526
14527table_server_id(<table>)
14528 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14529 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14530 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14531 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14532 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14533 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14534
14535table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14536 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14537 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014538 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014539 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14540 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14541 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14542 keyword.
14543
14544table_sess_rate(<table>)
14545 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14546 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14547 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14548 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14549 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14550 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14551 keyword.
14552
14553table_trackers(<table>)
14554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14556 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14557 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14558 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14559 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14560 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14561 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14562 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14563 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14564
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014565upper
14566 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14567 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14568 type. The result is of type string.
14569
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014570url_dec([<in_form>])
14571 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14572 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14573 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14574 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14575 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14576 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014577
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014578ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014579 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014580 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14581 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14582 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014583 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14584 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14585 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14586 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014587 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014588 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14589 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014590
14591 Example:
14592 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14593 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14594
14595 message Point {
14596 int32 latitude = 1;
14597 int32 longitude = 2;
14598 }
14599
14600 message PPoint {
14601 Point point = 59;
14602 }
14603
14604 message Rectangle {
14605 // One corner of the rectangle.
14606 PPoint lo = 48;
14607 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14608 PPoint hi = 49;
14609 }
14610
14611 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14612 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14613 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14614
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014615 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14616 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014617 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014618 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14619
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014620 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014621
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014622 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014623
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014624 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014625 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14626 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14627
14628 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14629 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14630 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14631
14632 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14633 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14634 interpret the previous binary sample.
14635
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014636
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014637unset-var(<var name>)
14638 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14639 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14640 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14641 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14642 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14643 response),
14644 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14646 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14647 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14648
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014649utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14650 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14651 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14652 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14653 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14654 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14655 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14656
14657 Example :
14658
14659 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014660 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014661 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14662
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014663word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14664 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14665 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14666 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014667 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014668 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14669 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14670
14671 Example :
14672 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14673 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14674 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14675 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14676 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014677 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014678
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014679wt6([<avalanche>])
14680 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14681 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14682 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14683 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14684 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14685 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14686 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014687 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14688 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014689
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014690xor(<value>)
14691 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014692 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014693 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014694 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014698 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014699 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14700 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014702 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014703
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014704xxh32([<seed>])
14705 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14706 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14707 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14708 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14709 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14710 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14711 as cryptographically secure.
14712
14713xxh64([<seed>])
14714 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14715 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14716 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14717 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14718 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14719 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14720 as cryptographically secure.
14721
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014722
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147237.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014724--------------------------------------------
14725
14726A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14727not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14728"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14729The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14730
14731always_false : boolean
14732 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14733 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14734
14735always_true : boolean
14736 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14737 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14738
14739avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014740 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14742 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14743 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14744 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14745 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14746 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14747 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14748 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14749 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14750 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14751 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14752 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14753 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014756 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14757 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14758 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14759 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014760 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14761
14762be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14764 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14765 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14766 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14767 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014768 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14769 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014770
14771 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14772 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14773 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14776 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14777 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14778 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14781 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014782
14783 Example :
14784 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14785 backend dynamic
14786 mode http
14787 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14788 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014789
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014791 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14792 of the string.
14793
14794bool(<bool>) : bool
14795 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14796 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14799 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014800 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14802 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014803
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014804 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014805 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014806 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14807
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014808 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14809 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014810
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014811 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014812 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014814 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014815 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014817 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014818
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014819 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14820 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014822 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014823
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014824cpu_calls : integer
14825 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14826 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14827 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14828 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14829 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14830 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14831
14832cpu_ns_avg : integer
14833 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14834 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14835 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14836 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14837 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14838 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14839 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14840 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14841 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14842 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14843 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14844
14845cpu_ns_tot : integer
14846 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14847 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14848 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14849 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14850 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14851 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14852 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14853 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14854 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14855 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14856 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14857 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14858 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14859
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014860date([<offset>]) : integer
14861 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14862 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14863 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14864 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014865 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14866
14867 Example :
14868
14869 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14870 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014871
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014872date_us : integer
14873 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14874 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14875 from the same timeval structure.
14876
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014877distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14878 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14879 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14880 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14881 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14882 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14883 list of supported tokens.
14884
14885distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14886 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14887 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14888 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14889 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14890 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14891 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14892 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14893 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14894 supported tokens.
14895
14896 Example :
14897 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14898 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14899 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14900 # send large files to the big farm
14901 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14902
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014903env(<name>) : string
14904 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14905 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14906 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14907 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14908 certain way.
14909
14910 Examples :
14911 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14912 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14913
14914 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14915 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14918 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014919 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14920 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14922 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014923 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14925 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014926
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014927fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14928 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14929 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14930 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14933 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14934 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14935 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14936 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14937 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14938 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14939 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14940 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014941
14942 Example :
14943 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14944 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14945 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14946 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14947 frontend mail
14948 bind :25
14949 mode tcp
14950 maxconn 100
14951 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14952 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14953 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14954 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014955
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014956hostname : string
14957 Returns the system hostname.
14958
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014959int(<integer>) : signed integer
14960 Returns a signed integer.
14961
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014962ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14963 Returns an ipv4.
14964
14965ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14966 Returns an ipv6.
14967
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014968lat_ns_avg : integer
14969 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14970 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14971 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14972 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14973 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14974 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14975 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14976 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14977 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14978 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14979 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14980 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14981 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14982 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14983
14984lat_ns_tot : integer
14985 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14986 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14987 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14988 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14989 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14990 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14991 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14992 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14993 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14994 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14995 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14996 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14997 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14998 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14999 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15000 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15001 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15002 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15003 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15004
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015005meth(<method>) : method
15006 Returns a method.
15007
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015008nbproc : integer
15009 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15010 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15011 and debugging purposes.
15012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15014 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15015 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15016 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015017 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15018 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15019 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015020
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015021prio_class : integer
15022 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15023 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15024 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15025
15026prio_offset : integer
15027 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15028 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15029 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15030 set-priority-offset".
15031
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015032proc : integer
15033 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15034 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15035 debugging purposes.
15036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015038 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15039 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15040 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15042 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15043 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15044 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15045 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15046
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015047rand([<range>]) : integer
15048 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15049 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15050 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15051 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15052 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15053
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015054uuid([<version>]) : string
15055 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15056 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15057 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15061 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15062 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15063 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15064 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015065 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15066 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15067
15068srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15070 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15071 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15072 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15073 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15074 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15075 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15076
15077 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15078 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079
15080srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15081 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15082 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15083 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015084 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015085 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15086 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15087 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15088
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015089srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15090 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15091 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15092 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15093 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15094 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15095 fetch methods.
15096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015097srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15098 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15099 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015100 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015101 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15102 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015103 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 overloading servers).
15105
15106 Example :
15107 # Redirect to a separate back
15108 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15109 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15110 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15111
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015112stopping : boolean
15113 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15114 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15115 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15116
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015117str(<string>) : string
15118 Returns a string.
15119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15121 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15122 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15123
15124table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15125 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15126 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15127 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15128
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015129thread : integer
15130 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15131 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15132 and debugging purposes.
15133
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015134var(<var-name>) : undefined
15135 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015136 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15137 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015138 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015139 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15140 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015141 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015142 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15143 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015144 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015145 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015146
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151477.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148----------------------------------
15149
15150The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15151closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15152methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15153sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15154TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015155the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15156counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015157"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15158used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15159can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15160Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15161table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15162tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15163currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015165bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015166 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15167 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15168 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170be_id : integer
15171 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15172 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15173
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015174be_name : string
15175 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15176 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178dst : ip
15179 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15180 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15181 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15182 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015183 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15184 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15185 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15186 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15187 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15188 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189
15190dst_conn : integer
15191 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15192 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15193 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15194 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15195 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15196 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15197 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15198 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015199
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015200dst_is_local : boolean
15201 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15202 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15203 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15204 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015206 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15207 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15208 it only once per connection.
15209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210dst_port : integer
15211 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15212 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15213 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15214 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15215 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15216 an HTTP header.
15217
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015218fc_http_major : integer
15219 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15220 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15221 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15222
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015223fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15224 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15225 header.
15226
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015227fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15228 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15229 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15230 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15231 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15232 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15233 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15234
15235fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15236 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15237 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15238 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15239 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15240 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15241 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15242
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015243fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015244 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15245 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15246 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15247 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15248
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015249fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015250 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15251 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15252 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15253 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15254
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015255fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015256 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15257 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15258 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15259 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15260
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015261fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015262 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15263 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15264 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15265 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15266
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015267fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015268 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15269 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15270 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15271 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15272
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015273fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015274 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15275 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15276 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15277 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15278
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015279fe_defbe : string
15280 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15281 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283fe_id : integer
15284 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015285 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15287
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015288fe_name : string
15289 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15290 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15291 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15292
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015293sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015294sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15295sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15296sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015297 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15298 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15299 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15300
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015301sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015302sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15303sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15304sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015305 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15306 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15307 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015309sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015310sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15311sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15312sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015313 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15314 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015315 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15316 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15317 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015318
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015319 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015320 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15321 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015322 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15323 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15324 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015325 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15326 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15327
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015328sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15329sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15330sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15331sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15332 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15333 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15334 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15335 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15336 when a first ACL was verified.
15337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015338sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015339sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15340sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15341sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015342 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015343 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015345sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015346sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15347sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15348sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015349 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15350 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15351 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15352
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015353sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015354sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15355sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15356sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015357 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15358 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15359 See also src_conn_rate.
15360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015361sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015362sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15363sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15364sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015365 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015366 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015367
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015368sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15369sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15370sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15371sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15372 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15373 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15374
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015375sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15376sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15377sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15378sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15379 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15380 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015382sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015383sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15384sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15385sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015386 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15387 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15388 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015389 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15390 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15391 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015392
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015393sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15394sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15396sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15397 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15398 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15399 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15400 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15401 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15402 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15403
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015404sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015405sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15406sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15407sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015408 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015409 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15410 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015412sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015413sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15414sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15415sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015416 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15417 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15418 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15419 src_http_err_rate.
15420
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015421sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015422sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15423sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15424sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015425 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015426 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15427 src_http_req_cnt.
15428
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015429sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015430sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15431sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15432sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015433 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15434 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15435 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15436 src_http_req_rate.
15437
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015438sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015439sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15440sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15441sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015442 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015443 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15444 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15445 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15446 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015447
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015448 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015449 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15450 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015451 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15452
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015453sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15454sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15455sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15456sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15457 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15458 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15459 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15460 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15461 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15462
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015463sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015464sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15465sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15466sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015467 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15468 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15469 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015471sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015472sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15473sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15474sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015475 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15476 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15477 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015479sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015480sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15481sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15482sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015483 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015484 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15485 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15486 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015487 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015488 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015490sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015491sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15492sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15493sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015494 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15495 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15496 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15497 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15498 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015499 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015500
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015501sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015502sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15503sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15504sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015505 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15506 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15507 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15508
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015509sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015510sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15511sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15512sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015513 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15514 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015515 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015516 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15517 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15519 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15520 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522so_id : integer
15523 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15524 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15525 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015526
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015527so_name : string
15528 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15529 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15530 strings instead of integers.
15531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015533 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15535 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15536 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015537 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15538 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15539 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015540 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15541 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15542 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15543 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15544 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15545 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15546 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015547
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015548 Example:
15549 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15550 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15553 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15554 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15555 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015556 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15559 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15560 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015561 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015562 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15565 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15566 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15567 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15568 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15569 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15570 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015571
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015572 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015573 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15574 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15575 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15576 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015577 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015578 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15579 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15580
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015581src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15582 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15583 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15584 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15585 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15586 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15587 was verified.
15588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015590 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015592 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015593 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015596 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15598 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015599 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15602 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15603 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15604 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015605 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015610 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015611 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015612
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015613src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15614 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15615 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15616 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15617 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15618
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015619src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15620 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15621 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15622 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15623 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015626 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015628 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15629 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015630 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15631 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15632 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015633
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015634src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15635 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15636 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15637 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15638 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15639 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15640 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15641 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015644 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015646 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015647 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15651 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15652 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15653 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15654 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015655 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015658 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15660 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015661 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15664 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15665 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15666 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015667 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015668 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15671 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15672 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15673 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015674 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15676 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015677
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015678 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015679 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015680 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015681 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015682
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015683src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15684 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15685 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15686 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15687 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15688 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15689 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15690
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015691src_is_local : boolean
15692 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15693 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15694 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15695 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015696 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015697 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15698 once per connection.
15699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015701 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15702 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15703 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15704 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15705 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015708 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15709 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15710 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15711 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15712 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714src_port : integer
15715 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15716 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15717 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15718 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015721 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015722 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15723 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15724 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015725 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15728 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15729 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15730 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15731 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015732 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15735 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15736 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15737 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15738 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15739 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15740 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15741 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15742 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015743
15744 Example :
15745 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15746 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15747 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15748 listen ssh
15749 bind :22
15750 mode tcp
15751 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015752 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015754 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756srv_id : integer
15757 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15758 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15759 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015760
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157617.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15765closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15766when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15767usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015768future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015769
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001577051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15771 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15772 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15773 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15774 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15775 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15776
15777 Example :
15778 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15779 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15780 # the request.
15781 frontend http-in
15782 bind *:8081
15783 default_backend servers
15784 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15785 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15786
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015787ssl_bc : boolean
15788 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15789 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15790 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15791
15792ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15793 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15794 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15795
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015796ssl_bc_alpn : string
15797 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15798 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015799 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015800 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15801 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15802 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15803 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15804 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15805 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15806
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015807ssl_bc_cipher : string
15808 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15809 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15810
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015811ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15812 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15813 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15814 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15815
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015816ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15817 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15818 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15819 session or a TLS ticket.
15820
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015821ssl_bc_npn : string
15822 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15823 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015824 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015825 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15826 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15827 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15828 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15829 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15830
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015831ssl_bc_protocol : string
15832 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15833 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15834
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015835ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015836 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015837 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15838 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015839
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015840ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15841 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15842 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15843 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15844
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015845ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15846 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15847 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15848 if session was reused or not.
15849
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015850ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15851 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15852 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15853 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15854 BoringSSL.
15855
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015856ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15857 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15858 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15861 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15862 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15863 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15864 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15865 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15868 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15869 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15870 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15871 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015872
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015873ssl_c_der : binary
15874 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15875 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15876 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878ssl_c_err : integer
15879 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15880 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15881 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15882 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15883 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15886 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15887 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15888 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15889 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15890 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15891 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15892 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15893 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895ssl_c_key_alg : string
15896 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15897 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15898 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900ssl_c_notafter : string
15901 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15902 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15903 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905ssl_c_notbefore : string
15906 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15907 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15908 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15911 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15912 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15913 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15914 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15915 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15916 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15917 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15918 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920ssl_c_serial : binary
15921 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15922 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15923 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15926 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15927 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15928 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015929 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15930 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15931
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015932 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015933 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15936 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15937 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15938 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940ssl_c_used : boolean
15941 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15942 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944ssl_c_verify : integer
15945 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15946 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15947 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15948 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950ssl_c_version : integer
15951 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15952 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015953
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015954ssl_f_der : binary
15955 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15956 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15957 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15960 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15961 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15962 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15963 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015964 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15966 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15967 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969ssl_f_key_alg : string
15970 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15971 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15972 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974ssl_f_notafter : string
15975 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15976 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15977 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979ssl_f_notbefore : string
15980 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15981 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15982 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15985 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15986 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15987 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15988 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15989 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15990 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15991 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15992 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994ssl_f_serial : binary
15995 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15996 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15997 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015998
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015999ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16000 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16001 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16002 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16005 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16006 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16007 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009ssl_f_version : integer
16010 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16011 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16012
16013ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016014 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16015 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16016 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018 Example :
16019 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16020 listen http-https
16021 bind :80
16022 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16023 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16024
16025ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16026 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16027 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16028
16029ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016030 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16032 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16033 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16034 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16035 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16036 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16037 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16038 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040ssl_fc_cipher : string
16041 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16042 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016043
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016044ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16045 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16046 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016047 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016048
16049ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16050 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16051 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016052 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016053
16054ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16055 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16056 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16057 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016058 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016059 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016060
16061ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16062 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16063 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016064 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016065
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016066ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16067 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16068 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16069 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016072 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16073 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016074 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16075 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16076 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16077 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016078
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016079ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16080 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16081 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16082 wait until the handshake happened.
16083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16085 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016086 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16087 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016088 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016089 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016090
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016091ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016092 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016093 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16094 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016097 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16099 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16100 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16101 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16102 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16103 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16104 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106ssl_fc_protocol : string
16107 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16108 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016109
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016110ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016111 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016112 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16113 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016114
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016115ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16116 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16117 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16118 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16121 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16122 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16123 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16124 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016125
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016126ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16127 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16128 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16129 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16130 BoringSSL.
16131
16132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133ssl_fc_sni : string
16134 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16135 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16136 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16137 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16138 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16139
16140 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16141 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16142 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016143 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016144 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16148 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16151 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16152 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016153
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016154
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161557.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16159sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16160only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16161For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16162be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16163can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16164sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16165for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16166content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016169 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16171 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16174 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016175 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016177
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016178req.hdrs : string
16179 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16180 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16181 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16182 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16183
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016184req.hdrs_bin : binary
16185 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16186 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16187 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16188 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16189 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16190 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16191
16192 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16193
16194 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16195 str: <int:length><bytes>
16196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197req.len : integer
16198req_len : integer (deprecated)
16199 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16200 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16201 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16202 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16203 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16204 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16205 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16206 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16209 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016210 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16211 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16212 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16213 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215 ACL alternatives :
16216 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16219 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16220 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16221 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16222 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224 ACL alternatives :
16225 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229req.proto_http : boolean
16230req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16231 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16232 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16233 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16234 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16235 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16236 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16237 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239 Example:
16240 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16241 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16242 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016243 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16246rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16247 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16248 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16249 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16250 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16251 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16252 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16253 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16256 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16257 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16258 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16259 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16260 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262 ACL derivatives :
16263 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016265 Example :
16266 listen tse-farm
16267 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16268 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16269 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16270 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16271 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16272 persist rdp-cookie
16273 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16274 # This is only useful makes sense if
16275 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16276 stick-table type string size 204800
16277 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16278 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16279 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16282 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016284req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16285rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16286 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16287 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16288 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16289 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291 ACL derivatives :
16292 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016293
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016294req.ssl_alpn : string
16295 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16296 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16297 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16298 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16299 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16300 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016301 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016302
16303 Examples :
16304 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16305 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16306 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016307 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016308 default_backend bk_default
16309
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016310req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16311 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16312 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016313 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16314 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16315 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16316 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16317 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16320req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16321 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16322 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16323 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16324 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16325 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16326 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16327 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329req.ssl_sni : string
16330req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16331 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16332 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16333 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16334 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16335 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16336 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16337 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16338 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16339 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16340 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16341 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16342 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344 ACL derivatives :
16345 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016347 Examples :
16348 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16349 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16350 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16351 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16352 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016353
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016354req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16355 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16356 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16357 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16358 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16359 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16360 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16361 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16362 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16363 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365req.ssl_ver : integer
16366req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16367 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16368 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16369 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16370 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16371 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16372 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16373 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016374 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377 ACL derivatives :
16378 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016379
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016380res.len : integer
16381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16382 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16383 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16384 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16385 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16386 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16387 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16388 content inspection.
16389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16391 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016392 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16393 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16394 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16395 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16398 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16399 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16400 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16401 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016403 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016404
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016405res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16406rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16407 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16408 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16409 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16410 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16411 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16412 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16413 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415wait_end : boolean
16416 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16417 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016418 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016419 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16420 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016421 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016422 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16423 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425 Examples :
16426 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16427 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16428 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16431 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16432 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16433 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16434 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16435 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16436 tcp-request content reject
16437
16438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164397.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016440--------------------------------------
16441
16442It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16443This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16444data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16445its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16446HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16447content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16448to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16449more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16450response are indexed.
16451
16452base : string
16453 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16454 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16455 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16456 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16457 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16458 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16459 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16460 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16461
16462 ACL derivatives :
16463 base : exact string match
16464 base_beg : prefix match
16465 base_dir : subdir match
16466 base_dom : domain match
16467 base_end : suffix match
16468 base_len : length match
16469 base_reg : regex match
16470 base_sub : substring match
16471
16472base32 : integer
16473 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16474 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16475 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016476 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16477 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16478 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479
16480base32+src : binary
16481 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16482 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16483 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16484 per-URL counters.
16485
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016486capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16487 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16488 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16489 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16490
16491capture.req.method : string
16492 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16493 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16494 because it's allocated.
16495
16496capture.req.uri : string
16497 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16498 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16499 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16500 allocated.
16501
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016502capture.req.ver : string
16503 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16504 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16505 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16506
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016507capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16508 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16509 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16510 The first entry is an index of 0.
16511 See also: "capture response header"
16512
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016513capture.res.ver : string
16514 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16515 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16516 persistent flag.
16517
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016518req.body : binary
16519 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16520 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16521 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16522 the first chunk is analyzed.
16523
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016524req.body_param([<name>) : string
16525 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16526 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16527 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16528 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16529 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16530 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16531 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16532 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16533 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16534 given.
16535
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016536req.body_len : integer
16537 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16538 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16539 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16540 "option http-buffer-request".
16541
16542req.body_size : integer
16543 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16544 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16545 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16546 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16547 "option http-buffer-request".
16548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016549req.cook([<name>]) : string
16550cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16551 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16552 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16553 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16554 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16555 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16556 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16557 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16558 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16559
16560 ACL derivatives :
16561 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16562 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16563 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16564 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16565 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16566 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16567 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16568 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016570req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16571cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16572 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16573 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16576cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16577 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16578 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16579 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16580 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16583 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16584 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16585 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16586 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016587 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016588 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16589 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16590 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16591 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16594 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16595 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16596 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16597 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016598 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16601 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16602 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16603 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16604 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16605 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16606 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16607 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16608 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16611 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16612 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16613 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16614 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16617 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16618 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16619 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16620 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16621 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16622 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16623 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16624 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016625 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016627 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629 ACL derivatives :
16630 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16631 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16632 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16633 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16634 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16635 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16636 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16637 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16638
16639req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16640hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16641 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16642 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16643 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16644 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16645 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16646 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16647 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16648 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16649 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16650
16651req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16652hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16653 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16654 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16655 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16656 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16657 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016658 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16660 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16661
16662req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16663hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16664 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16665 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16666 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16667 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16668 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16669 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16670 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16671
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016672
16673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16675 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16676 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16677 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16678 basic auth is supported.
16679
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016680http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16681 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16682 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16683 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16684 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016685 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16686 basic auth is supported.
16687
16688 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016689 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16690 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16691 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16692 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016693
16694http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016695 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16696 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016697 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16698 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016700method : integer + string
16701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16702 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16703 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16704 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16705 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16706 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16707 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709 ACL derivatives :
16710 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712 Example :
16713 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16714 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16715 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016717path : string
16718 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16719 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16720 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16721 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16722 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016723 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726 ACL derivatives :
16727 path : exact string match
16728 path_beg : prefix match
16729 path_dir : subdir match
16730 path_dom : domain match
16731 path_end : suffix match
16732 path_len : length match
16733 path_reg : regex match
16734 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016735
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016736query : string
16737 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16738 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16739 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16740 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016741 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016742 which stops before the question mark.
16743
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016744req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16745 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16746 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16747 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16748 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016750req.ver : string
16751req_ver : string (deprecated)
16752 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16753 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16754 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756 ACL derivatives :
16757 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759res.comp : boolean
16760 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16761 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16762 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764res.comp_algo : string
16765 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16766 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16767 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016769res.cook([<name>]) : string
16770scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16771 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16772 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16773 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775 ACL derivatives :
16776 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16779scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16780 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16781 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16782 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16785scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16786 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16787 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16788 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16791 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16792 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16793 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16794 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16795 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16796 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16797 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16798 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16799 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16802 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16803 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16804 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16805 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16806 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16809shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16810 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16811 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16812 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16813 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16814 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16815 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16816 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16817 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819 ACL derivatives :
16820 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16821 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16822 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16823 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16824 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16825 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16826 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16827 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16828
16829res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16830shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16831 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16832 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16833 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16834 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16835 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016837res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16838shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16839 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16840 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16841 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16842 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16843 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16844 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016845
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016846res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16847 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16848 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16849 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16850 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16853shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16854 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16855 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16856 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16857 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16858 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16859 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016861res.ver : string
16862resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16863 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16864 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866 ACL derivatives :
16867 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16870 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16871 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016872 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016873 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16876 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878status : integer
16879 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16880 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16881 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016882
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016883unique-id : string
16884 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16885 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16886 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16887 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16888 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16889 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016891url : string
16892 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16893 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16894 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16895 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16896 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16897 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16898 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900 ACL derivatives :
16901 url : exact string match
16902 url_beg : prefix match
16903 url_dir : subdir match
16904 url_dom : domain match
16905 url_end : suffix match
16906 url_len : length match
16907 url_reg : regex match
16908 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016910url_ip : ip
16911 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16912 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16913 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16914 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16915 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16916 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16917 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919url_port : integer
16920 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16921 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16922 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16923 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016924
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016925urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16926url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016927 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16928 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016929 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16930 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16931 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16932 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16934 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016935 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16936 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938 ACL derivatives :
16939 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16940 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16941 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16942 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16943 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16944 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16945 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16946 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016947
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016949 Example :
16950 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16951 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16952 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16953 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016954
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016955urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016956 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16957 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16958 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016959
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016960url32 : integer
16961 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16962 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16963 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16964 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16965 is an unsigned integer.
16966
16967url32+src : binary
16968 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16969 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16970 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16971
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169737.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016974---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016976Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16977every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016978order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016980ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16981---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016982FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016983HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016984HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16985HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016986HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16987HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16988HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16989HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16990LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016991METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016992METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016993METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16994METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16995METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16996METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016997METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016998METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016999RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017000REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017001TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017002WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17003---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017004
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170068. Logging
17007----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017008
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17010provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17011very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17012provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17013state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017014to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017015headers.
17016
17017In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17018about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17019send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17020
17021 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17022 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17023 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17024 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17025 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017026 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017027 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017028
17029The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17030allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17031as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17032while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17033real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17034delay.
17035
17036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170378.1. Log levels
17038---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017040TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017041source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017042HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17043in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17044track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17045syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17046about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017047
17048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170498.2. Log formats
17050----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017051
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017052HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017053and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17054slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17055options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017056
17057 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17058 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17059 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17060 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17061 extents.
17062
17063 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17064 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17065 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17066 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17067 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17068
17069 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17070 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17071 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17072 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17073 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17074
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017075 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17076 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17077 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17078 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17079
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017080 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17081
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017082Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17083specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17084field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17085servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17086always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17087identifier.
17088
17089Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17090 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17091 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17092 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17093 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17094
17095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170968.2.1. Default log format
17097-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017098
17099This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17100as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17101format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17102
17103 Example :
17104 listen www
17105 mode http
17106 log global
17107 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17108
17109 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17110 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17111 (www/HTTP)
17112
17113 Field Format Extract from the example above
17114 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17115 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17116 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17117 4 'to' to
17118 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17119 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17120
17121Detailed fields description :
17122 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17123 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17124 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17125 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17126 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17127 and processed the connection.
17128 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17129
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017130In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17131"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17132connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17133
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017134It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17135will eventually disappear.
17136
17137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171388.2.2. TCP log format
17139---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017140
17141The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17142is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17143information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17144counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17145emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17146environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17147the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17148sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017149specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17150not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17151fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17152marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017153
17154 Example :
17155 frontend fnt
17156 mode tcp
17157 option tcplog
17158 log global
17159 default_backend bck
17160
17161 backend bck
17162 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17163
17164 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17165 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17166 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17167
17168 Field Format Extract from the example above
17169 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17170 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17171 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17172 4 frontend_name fnt
17173 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17174 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17175 7 bytes_read* 212
17176 8 termination_state --
17177 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17178 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17179
17180Detailed fields description :
17181 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017182 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17183 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17184 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017185 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017186 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017187 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017188
17189 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017190 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17191 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17192 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017193
17194 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17195 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17196 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017197 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17198 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17199 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17200 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201
17202 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17203 and processed the connection.
17204
17205 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17206 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17207 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17208 applications.
17209
17210 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17211 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17212 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17213 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17214 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17215
17216 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17217 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17218 See "Timers" below for more details.
17219
17220 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17221 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17222 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17223 "Timers" below for more details.
17224
17225 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017226 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017227 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17228 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17229 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17230 details.
17231
17232 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17233 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17234 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17235 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17236 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17237
17238 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17239 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17240 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17241 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17242 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17243 for more details.
17244
17245 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017246 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17248 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17249 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017250 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017251
17252 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17253 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17254 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17255 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17256 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17257 caused by a denial of service attack.
17258
17259 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17260 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17261 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17262 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17263 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17264 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17265 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17266 denial of service attack.
17267
17268 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17269 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17270 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17271 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17272 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17273 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17274 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17275 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17276 be processed than on other servers.
17277
17278 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17279 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17280 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17281 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17282 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17283 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17284 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17285 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17286 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17287 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17288 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17289 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17290 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17291
17292 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17293 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17294 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17295 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17296 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17297 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017298 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017299 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17300
17301 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17302 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17303 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17304 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17305 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17306 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017307 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17309 occurs.
17310
17311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173128.2.3. HTTP log format
17313----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017314
17315The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17316is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17317the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17318are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17319emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17320generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17321"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17322which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017323frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17324is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325
17326Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17327slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17328with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17329
17330 Example :
17331 frontend http-in
17332 mode http
17333 option httplog
17334 log global
17335 default_backend bck
17336
17337 backend static
17338 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17339
17340 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17341 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17342 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017343 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344
17345 Field Format Extract from the example above
17346 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17347 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017348 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017349 4 frontend_name http-in
17350 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017351 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352 7 status_code 200
17353 8 bytes_read* 2750
17354 9 captured_request_cookie -
17355 10 captured_response_cookie -
17356 11 termination_state ----
17357 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17358 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17359 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17360 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17361 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017362
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017363Detailed fields description :
17364 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017365 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17366 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17367 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017368 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017369 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017370 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017371
17372 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017373 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17374 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17375 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017377 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17378 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017379
17380 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17381 and processed the connection.
17382
17383 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17384 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17385 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17386
17387 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17388 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17389 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17390 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17391 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17392 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17393
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017394 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17395 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17396 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017397 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017398 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17399 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017400 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17401 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017402
17403 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17404 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017405 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406
17407 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17408 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017409 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17410 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017411
17412 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17413 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17414 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17415 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17416 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017417 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17418 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017419
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017420 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17421 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17422 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17423 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17424 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17425 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17426 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017427 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017428
17429 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17430 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17431 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17432
17433 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17434 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017435 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017436 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17437 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17438 overflowing.
17439
17440 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17441 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17442 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17443 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17444 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17445 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17446 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17447 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17448
17449 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17450 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17451 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17452 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17453 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17454 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17455 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17456 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17457
17458 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17459 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17460 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17461 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17462 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17463 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17464 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17465
17466 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017467 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17469 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17470 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017471 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017472 system.
17473
17474 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17475 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17476 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17477 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17478 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17479 caused by a denial of service attack.
17480
17481 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17482 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17483 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17484 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17485 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17486 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17487 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17488 denial of service attack.
17489
17490 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17491 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17492 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17493 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17494 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17495 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17496 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17497 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17498 processed than on other servers.
17499
17500 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17501 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17502 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17503 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17504 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17505 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17506 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17507 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17508 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17509 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17510 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17511 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17512 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17513
17514 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17515 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17516 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17517 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17518 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17519 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017520 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017521 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17522
17523 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17524 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17525 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17526 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17527 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17528 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017529 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017530 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17531 occurs.
17532
17533 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17534 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17535 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17536 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17537 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17538 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17539 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17540 cookies" below for more details.
17541
17542 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17543 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17544 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17545 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17546 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17547 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17548 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17549 and cookies" below for more details.
17550
17551 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17552 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17553 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17554 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17555 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17556 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17557 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17558 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17559
17560
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175618.2.4. Custom log format
17562------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017563
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017564The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017565mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017566
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017567HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017568Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17569separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17570prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17571
17572Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17573variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017574("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017575
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017576If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017577as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017578less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17579the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17580
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017581Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017582In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017583in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017584
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017585Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17586'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17587https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17588such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17589
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017590Flags are :
17591 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017592 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017593 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17594 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017595
17596 Example:
17597
17598 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17600
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017601 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17602
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017603At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17604
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017605 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17606 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017607
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017608the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017609
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017610 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17611 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17612 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017613
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017614and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017616 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17617 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017618
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017619Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17620
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017621 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017622 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017623 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17624 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17625 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017626 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17627 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17628 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017629 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017630 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17631 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017632 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017633 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17634 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017635 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017636 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017637 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017638 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017639 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017640 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017641 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017642 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17643 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17644 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17645 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17646 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017647 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017648 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17649 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017650 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017651 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17652 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017653 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17654 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17655 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017656 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017657 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17658 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017659 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017660 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17661 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17662 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017663 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017664 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017665 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17666 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17667 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17668 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017669 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017670 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017671 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017672 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017673 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017674 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017675 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17676 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17677 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017678 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017679 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17680 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017681 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017682 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17683 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017684 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017685 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017686 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017687 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017688
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017689 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017690
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017691
176928.2.5. Error log format
17693-----------------------
17694
17695When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17696protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17697By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17698"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017699will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017700logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17701
17702The format looks like this :
17703
17704 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17705 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17706 Connection error during SSL handshake
17707
17708 Field Format Extract from the example above
17709 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17710 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17711 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17712 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17713 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17714
17715These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17716failures.
17717
17718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177198.3. Advanced logging options
17720-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017721
17722Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17723just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17724options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17725for more information about their usage.
17726
17727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177288.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17729------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730
17731It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17732haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17733commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17734monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17735ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17736
17737 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17738 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17739 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17740 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17741
17742 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17743 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17744 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017745 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017746 such as other load-balancers.
17747
17748 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17749 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17750 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17751
17752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177538.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17754----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017755
17756The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17757what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17758or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017759"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017760just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17761log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17762after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17763is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17764with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17765with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17766
17767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177688.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17769------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017770
17771Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17772for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17773"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17774retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17775raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17776a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17777file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17778you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17779"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17780
17781
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17783--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017784
17785Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17786multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17787them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17788"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17789logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17790error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17791and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17792too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17793useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17794alternative.
17795
17796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177978.4. Timing events
17798------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017799
17800Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17801reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17802the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17803frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017804mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17805addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17806
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017807Timings events in HTTP mode:
17808
17809 first request 2nd request
17810 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17811 t tr t tr ...
17812 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17813 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17814 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17815 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17816 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17817
17818Timings events in TCP mode:
17819
17820 TCP session
17821 |<----------------->|
17822 t t
17823 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17824 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17825 |<------ Tt ------->|
17826
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017827 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017828 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017829 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17830 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17831 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017833 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17834 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17835 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17836 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017837
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017838 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17839 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17840 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017841 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17842 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17843 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17844 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17845 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17846 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017847
17848 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17849 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17850 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17851 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17852 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17853 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17854 request typed by hand during a test.
17855
17856 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17857 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017858 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017859 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17860 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17861 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17862 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863
17864 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17865 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17866 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17867 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17868 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17869
17870 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17871 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17872 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17873 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17874 connection never established.
17875
17876 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17877 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17878 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17879 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17880 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17881 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17882 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17883 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17884 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17885 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17886 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17887
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017888 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17889 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17890 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17891 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17892 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17893 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17894
17895 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17896
17897 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17898 "Ta" can never be negative.
17899
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017900 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17901 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017902 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17903 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017904 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017906 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017907
17908 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017909 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17910 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017911
17912These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17913protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17914that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017915due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17916"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17917that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017918
17919Most common cases :
17920
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017921 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17922 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17923 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17924 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17925 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17926 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17927 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17928 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17929 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17930 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17931 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017932 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017933
17934 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17935 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17936 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17937 of ms on remote networks.
17938
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017939 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17940 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17941 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017942
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017943 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17944 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17945 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17946 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17947 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17948 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17949 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17950 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17951 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017952
17953Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17954
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017955 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017956 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017957 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017958
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017959 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017960 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17961 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017963 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017964 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17965 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17966 flags.
17967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017968 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17969 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017970 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17971 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17972 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17973 the client connection was maintained open.
17974
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017975 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017976 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017977 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017978 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17979
17980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179818.5. Session state at disconnection
17982-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017983
17984TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17985"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179862-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17987each of which has a special meaning :
17988
17989 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17990 session to terminate :
17991
17992 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17993
17994 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17995 server explicitly refused it.
17996
17997 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17998 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17999 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18000 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018001 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018002
18003 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18004 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018005
18006 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18007 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18008 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18009 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18010 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18011
18012 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18013 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18014 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18015 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18016 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18017
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018018 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18019 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18020
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018021 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18022 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18023 backup connections when going up.
18024
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018025 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018027 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18028 send or receive data.
18029
18030 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18031 send or receive data.
18032
18033 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18034 with nothing left in the buffers.
18035
18036 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18037
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018038 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018039 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18040
18041 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18042 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18043 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18044 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18045 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18046
18047 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18048 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18049
18050 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18051 server (HTTP only).
18052
18053 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18054
18055 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18056 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18057 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18058
18059 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18060 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18061 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18062
18063 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18064
18065 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18066 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18067
18068 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18069 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18070 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18071
18072 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18073 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018074 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18075 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018076
18077 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18078 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18079 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18080 another server.
18081
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018082 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018083 server.
18084
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018085 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18086 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18087 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18088 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18089
18090 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18091 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18092 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18093 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18094
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018095 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18096 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18097 "use-server" rule).
18098
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018099 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18100
18101 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18102 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18103
18104 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18105
18106 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18107 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18108 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18109
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018110 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18111 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018112 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018113 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18114 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18115
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018116 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18117
18118 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18119 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18120
18121 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18122
18123 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18124
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018125The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18126was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018127helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18128starvation, attacks, etc...
18129
18130The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18131alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18132easier finding and understanding.
18133
18134 Flags Reason
18135
18136 -- Normal termination.
18137
18138 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18139 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18140 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18141 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18142
18143 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18144 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18145 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18146 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18147 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18148 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018149
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018150 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18151 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018152 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018153
18154 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18155 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18156 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18157
18158 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18159 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18160 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18161 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18162 the server takes too long to respond.
18163
18164 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18165 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18166 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18167 long a time to respond.
18168
18169 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18170 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18171 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18172 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018173 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18174 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018175
18176 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18177 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18178 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18179 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18180 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018181 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018182 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18183 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18184 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18185 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18186 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18187 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18188 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18189 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018190 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018191 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18192 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18193 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018194
18195 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18196 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018197 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18198 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18199 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18200 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018201
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018202 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18203 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018205 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018206 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18207 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018208 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018209 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18210 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18211
18212 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18213 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18214 503 or 504 here.
18215
18216 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18217 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18218 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18219 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18220 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18221
18222 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18223 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018224 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018225 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18226 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18227
18228 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18229 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18230 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18231 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18232 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18233 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18234 between haproxy and the server.
18235
18236 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18237 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18238 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18239 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18240 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18241 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18242 solution is to fix the application.
18243
18244 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18245 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18246 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18247 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18248 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18249 external attacks.
18250
18251 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18252 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018253 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018254 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18255 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18256
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018257 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18258 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18259 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018260 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018261 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018262
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018263 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18264 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18265 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18266 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018267 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18268 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18269 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18270 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18271 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018272
18273 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18274 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18275 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18276 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18277
18278 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18279 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18280 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18281 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18282
18283 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18284 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18285 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18286 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18287
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018288The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18289persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18290important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18291re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18292
18293 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18294
18295 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18296 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18297 set on a GET request.
18298
18299 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18300 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018301 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018302 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18303
18304 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18305 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18306 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18307
18308 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18309 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18310 already got a cookie.
18311
18312 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18313 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18314 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18315 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18316 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18317
18318 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18319 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18320 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18321
18322 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18323 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18324 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18325
18326 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18327 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18328
18329 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18330 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18331 then advertised in the response.
18332
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183348.6. Non-printable characters
18335-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018336
18337In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18338consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18339converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18340prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18341being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18342escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18343is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18344'}' when logging headers.
18345
18346Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18347issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18348containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18349
18350Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18351the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18352performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18353
18354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183558.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18356---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018357
18358Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18359achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018360section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018361cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18362the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18363the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018364locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018365not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18366user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18367a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18368wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18369
18370 Examples :
18371 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18372 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18373
18374 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18375 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18376
18377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183788.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18379---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018380
18381Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18382proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18383the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18384server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18385
18386Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18387response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018388section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018389
18390It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018391time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18392appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018393are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18394and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18395follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18396request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18397in the logs.
18398
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018399As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18400frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18401an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18402
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403 Example :
18404 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18405 listen proxy-out
18406 mode http
18407 option httplog
18408 option logasap
18409 log global
18410 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18411
18412 # log the name of the virtual server
18413 capture request header Host len 20
18414
18415 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18416 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18417
18418 # log the beginning of the referrer
18419 capture request header Referer len 20
18420
18421 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18422 capture response header Server len 20
18423
18424 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18425 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018427 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018428 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18429
18430 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18431 capture response header Via len 20
18432
18433 # log the URL location during a redirection
18434 capture response header Location len 20
18435
18436 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18437 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18438 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18439 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18440 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18441
18442 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18443 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18444 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18445 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018446 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018447
18448 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18449 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18450 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18451 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18452 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018453 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018454
18455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184568.9. Examples of logs
18457---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018458
18459These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18460them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18461reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18462
18463 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18464 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18465 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18466
18467 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18468 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18469
18470 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18471 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18472 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18473
18474 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18475 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18476
18477 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18478 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18479 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18480
18481 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018482 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018483 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18484 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18485
18486 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18487 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18488 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18489
18490 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18491 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018492 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018493 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18494 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18495 to return the 502 and not the server.
18496
18497 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018498 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018499
18500 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18501 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18502 Nothing was sent to any server.
18503
18504 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18505 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18506
18507 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18508 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018509 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018510 send a 408 return code to the client.
18511
18512 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18513 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18514
18515 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18516 5 seconds ("c----").
18517
18518 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18519 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018520 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018521
18522 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018523 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018524 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18525 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18526 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18527 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18528 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018529
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018530
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185319. Supported filters
18532--------------------
18533
18534Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18535accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18536unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18537
18538See also : "filter"
18539
185409.1. Trace
18541----------
18542
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018543filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018544
18545 Arguments:
18546 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18547 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18548
18549 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18550 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18551 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18552 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18553
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018554 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018555 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18556 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18557 amount of the parsed data.
18558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018559 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018560
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018561This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18562callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18563information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18564filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18565
18566Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18567tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18568a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18569
18570
185719.2. HTTP compression
18572---------------------
18573
18574filter compression
18575
18576The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18577keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018578when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18579it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18580response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18581line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18582cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18583the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018584
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018585See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018586
18587
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185889.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18589--------------------------------------------
18590
18591filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18592
18593 Arguments :
18594
18595 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18596 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18597 parsed.
18598
18599 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18600 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18601 part must be placed in its own scope.
18602
18603The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18604external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018605streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018606exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18607also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18608
18609SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18610the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18611
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018612For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018613"doc/SPOE.txt".
18614
18615Important note:
18616 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18617 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18618
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186199.4. Cache
18620----------
18621
18622filter cache <name>
18623
18624 Arguments :
18625
18626 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18627
18628The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18629"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018630cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018631other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18632the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18633mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18634filter other than the compression is used for the same
18635listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18636order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018637
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018638See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018639
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001864010. Cache
18641---------
18642
18643HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18644(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18645RAM.
18646
18647The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018648this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018649
18650If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18651independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18652when we try to allocate a new one.
18653
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018654The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018655
18656It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18657"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18658for more details.
18659
18660When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18661replaced by "<CACHE>".
18662
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001866310.1. Limitation
18664----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018665
18666The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18667
18668- If the response is not a 200
18669- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018670- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018671- If the response is not cacheable
18672
18673- If the request is not a GET
18674- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018675- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018676
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018677Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18678filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18679can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18680example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18681"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018682
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868310.2. Setup
18684-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018685
18686To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18687the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18688
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868910.2.1. Cache section
18690---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018691
18692cache <name>
18693 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18694 size of cache is mandatory.
18695
18696total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018697 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018698 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018699
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018700max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018701 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18702 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18703 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018704
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018705max-age <seconds>
18706 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18707 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18708 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18709 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18710 default.
18711
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001871210.2.2. Proxy section
18713---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018714
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018715http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018716 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18717 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18718 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18719 after this one.
18720
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018721http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018722 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18723 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18724 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18725 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18726
18727
18728Example:
18729
18730 backend bck1
18731 mode http
18732
18733 http-request cache-use foobar
18734 http-response cache-store foobar
18735 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18736
18737 cache foobar
18738 total-max-size 4
18739 max-age 240
18740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018741/*
18742 * Local variables:
18743 * fill-column: 79
18744 * End:
18745 */